re PR rtl-optimization/45394 (gnat fails to build on s390, trunk 20100918)
[gcc.git] / gcc / reload1.c
1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GCC.
7
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
12
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26
27 #include "machmode.h"
28 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
29 #include "rtl-error.h"
30 #include "tm_p.h"
31 #include "obstack.h"
32 #include "insn-config.h"
33 #include "flags.h"
34 #include "function.h"
35 #include "expr.h"
36 #include "optabs.h"
37 #include "regs.h"
38 #include "addresses.h"
39 #include "basic-block.h"
40 #include "df.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "recog.h"
43 #include "output.h"
44 #include "except.h"
45 #include "tree.h"
46 #include "ira.h"
47 #include "target.h"
48 #include "emit-rtl.h"
49
50 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
51 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
52 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
53 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
54 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
55 that need them.
56
57 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
58 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
59 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
60
61 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
62 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
63 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
64
65 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
66 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
67 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
68 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
69 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
70 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
71 until the process stabilizes.
72
73 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
74 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
75 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
76
77 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
78 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
79 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
80 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
81 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
82 into the reload registers. */
83 \f
84 struct target_reload default_target_reload;
85 #if SWITCHABLE_TARGET
86 struct target_reload *this_target_reload = &default_target_reload;
87 #endif
88
89 #define spill_indirect_levels \
90 (this_target_reload->x_spill_indirect_levels)
91
92 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
93 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
94 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
95
96 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
97 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
98 static regset_head reg_has_output_reload;
99
100 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
101 in the current insn. */
102 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
103
104 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
105 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
106 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
107 with the constant it stands for. */
108 rtx *reg_equiv_constant;
109
110 /* Element N is an invariant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
111 eliminate_regs_in_insn uses this to replace pseudos in particular
112 contexts. */
113 rtx *reg_equiv_invariant;
114
115 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
116 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
117 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
118 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
119 rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;
120
121 /* We allocate reg_equiv_memory_loc inside a varray so that the garbage
122 collector can keep track of what is inside. */
123 VEC(rtx,gc) *reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec;
124
125 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
126 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
127 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
128 rtx *reg_equiv_address;
129
130 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
131 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
132 rtx *reg_equiv_mem;
133
134 /* Element N is an EXPR_LIST of REG_EQUIVs containing MEMs with
135 alternate representations of the location of pseudo reg N. */
136 rtx *reg_equiv_alt_mem_list;
137
138 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
139 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
140
141 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
142 constant or memory slot. */
143 rtx *reg_equiv_init;
144 int reg_equiv_init_size;
145
146 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
147 static short *reg_old_renumber;
148
149 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
150 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
151 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
152 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
153 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
154
155 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
156 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
157 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
158 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
159
160 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid. */
161 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
162 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
163 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
164 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
165
166 /* Indicate whether the register's current value is one that is not
167 safe to retain across a call, even for registers that are normally
168 call-saved. This is only meaningful for members of reg_reloaded_valid. */
169 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered;
170
171 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
172 static int n_spills;
173
174 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
175 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
176 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
177 the proper mode. */
178 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
179
180 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
181 that was stored after the last time it was used.
182 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
183 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
184
185 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
186 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
187 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
188 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
189
190 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
191 indexed by hard reg number,
192 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
193 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
194
195 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
196 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
197
198 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
199 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
200 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
201 registers. */
202 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
203
204 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
205 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
206 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
207 to retry register allocation. */
208 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
209
210 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
211 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
212 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
213
214 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
215 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
216 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
217 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
218 is calculated during finish_spills. */
219 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
220
221 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
222 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
223 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
224 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
225 terminate. */
226 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
227
228 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
229 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
230 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
231 pseudo is live. */
232 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
233
234 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
235 marked in this set. */
236 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
237
238 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
239 a round-robin fashion. */
240 static int last_spill_reg;
241
242 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
243 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
244
245 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
246 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
247
248 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
249 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
250
251 /* Record which pseudos changed their allocation in finish_spills. */
252 static regset_head changed_allocation_pseudos;
253
254 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
255 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
256 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
257
258 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
259 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
260 int reload_first_uid;
261
262 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
263 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
264 int caller_save_needed;
265
266 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
267 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
268 int reload_in_progress = 0;
269
270 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
271 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
272 insn. */
273 static struct obstack reload_obstack;
274
275 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
276 are allocated first. */
277 static char *reload_startobj;
278
279 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
280 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
281 static char *reload_firstobj;
282
283 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
284 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
285 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
286
287 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
288 examine. */
289 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
290
291 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
292 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
293 \f
294 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
295 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
296 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
297 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
298
299 struct elim_table
300 {
301 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
302 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
303 HOST_WIDE_INT initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
304 int can_eliminate; /* Nonzero if this elimination can be done. */
305 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value returned by TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
306 target hook in previous scan over insns
307 made by reload. */
308 HOST_WIDE_INT offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
309 HOST_WIDE_INT previous_offset;/* Offset at end of previous insn. */
310 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
311 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
312 We cannot simply compare the number since
313 we might then spuriously replace a hard
314 register corresponding to a pseudo
315 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
316 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
317 };
318
319 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
320
321 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
322 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
323 static const struct elim_table_1
324 {
325 const int from;
326 const int to;
327 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
328
329 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
330 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
331 replaced by the stack pointer. */
332
333 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
334 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
335 #else
336 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
337 #endif
338
339 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
340
341 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
342 to their initial offset. If nonzero, we use a new copy of each
343 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
344 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
345
346 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
347 static int num_eliminable;
348 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
349 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
350 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
351
352 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
353 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
354 elimination. This information is indexed by the difference of the
355 number of the label and the first label number. We can't offset the
356 pointer itself as this can cause problems on machines with segmented
357 memory. The first table is an array of flags that records whether we
358 have yet encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays,
359 one entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
360
361 static int first_label_num;
362 static char *offsets_known_at;
363 static HOST_WIDE_INT (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
364
365 /* Stack of addresses where an rtx has been changed. We can undo the
366 changes by popping items off the stack and restoring the original
367 value at each location.
368
369 We use this simplistic undo capability rather than copy_rtx as copy_rtx
370 will not make a deep copy of a normally sharable rtx, such as
371 (const (plus (symbol_ref) (const_int))). If such an expression appears
372 as R1 in gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p, then a shared
373 rtx expression would be changed. See PR 42431. */
374
375 typedef rtx *rtx_p;
376 DEF_VEC_P(rtx_p);
377 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(rtx_p,heap);
378 static VEC(rtx_p,heap) *substitute_stack;
379
380 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
381
382 static int num_labels;
383 \f
384 static void replace_pseudos_in (rtx *, enum machine_mode, rtx);
385 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms (void);
386 static void copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *);
387 static void calculate_needs_all_insns (int);
388 static int find_reg (struct insn_chain *, int);
389 static void find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
390 static void select_reload_regs (void);
391 static void delete_caller_save_insns (void);
392
393 static void spill_failure (rtx, enum reg_class);
394 static void count_spilled_pseudo (int, int, int);
395 static void delete_dead_insn (rtx);
396 static void alter_reg (int, int, bool);
397 static void set_label_offsets (rtx, rtx, int);
398 static void check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx);
399 static void elimination_effects (rtx, enum machine_mode);
400 static rtx eliminate_regs_1 (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, bool, bool);
401 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx, int);
402 static void update_eliminable_offsets (void);
403 static void mark_not_eliminable (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
404 static void set_initial_elim_offsets (void);
405 static bool verify_initial_elim_offsets (void);
406 static void set_initial_label_offsets (void);
407 static void set_offsets_for_label (rtx);
408 static void init_eliminable_invariants (rtx, bool);
409 static void init_elim_table (void);
410 static void free_reg_equiv (void);
411 static void update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *);
412 static void elimination_costs_in_insn (rtx);
413 static void spill_hard_reg (unsigned int, int);
414 static int finish_spills (int);
415 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx);
416 static void count_pseudo (int);
417 static void order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *);
418 static void reload_as_needed (int);
419 static void forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
420 static void forget_marked_reloads (regset);
421 static int reload_reg_class_lower (const void *, const void *);
422 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
423 enum machine_mode);
424 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
425 enum machine_mode);
426 static int reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
427 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int, int, int, enum reload_type,
428 rtx, rtx, int, int);
429 static int free_for_value_p (int, enum machine_mode, int, enum reload_type,
430 rtx, rtx, int, int);
431 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
432 static int allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *, int, int);
433 static int conflicts_with_override (rtx);
434 static void failed_reload (rtx, int);
435 static int set_reload_reg (int, int);
436 static void choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *, rtx *);
437 static void choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
438 static void emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
439 rtx, int);
440 static void emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
441 int);
442 static void do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
443 static void do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
444 static void emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *);
445 static void delete_output_reload (rtx, int, int, rtx);
446 static void delete_address_reloads (rtx, rtx);
447 static void delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx, rtx, rtx);
448 static rtx inc_for_reload (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
449 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
450 static void add_auto_inc_notes (rtx, rtx);
451 #endif
452 static void substitute (rtx *, const_rtx, rtx);
453 static bool gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int, int);
454 static int reloads_conflict (int, int);
455 static rtx gen_reload (rtx, rtx, int, enum reload_type);
456 static rtx emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx);
457 \f
458 /* Initialize the reload pass. This is called at the beginning of compilation
459 and may be called again if the target is reinitialized. */
460
461 void
462 init_reload (void)
463 {
464 int i;
465
466 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
467 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
468 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
469
470 rtx tem
471 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
472 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
473 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
474 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
475 GEN_INT (4)));
476 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
477
478 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
479 {
480 spill_indirect_levels++;
481 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
482 }
483
484 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
485
486 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
487 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
488
489 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
490
491 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
492 {
493 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
494 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
495 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
496
497 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
498 tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);
499
500 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
501 {
502 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
503 break;
504 }
505 }
506
507 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
508 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
509 reload_startobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
510
511 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
512 INIT_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
513 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
514 }
515
516 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
517 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
518
519 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
520 struct insn_chain *
521 new_insn_chain (void)
522 {
523 struct insn_chain *c;
524
525 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
526 {
527 c = XOBNEW (&reload_obstack, struct insn_chain);
528 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
529 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
530 }
531 else
532 {
533 c = unused_insn_chains;
534 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
535 }
536 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
537 c->need_operand_change = 0;
538 c->need_reload = 0;
539 c->need_elim = 0;
540 return c;
541 }
542
543 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
544 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
545
546 void
547 compute_use_by_pseudos (HARD_REG_SET *to, regset from)
548 {
549 unsigned int regno;
550 reg_set_iterator rsi;
551
552 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno, rsi)
553 {
554 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
555
556 if (r < 0)
557 {
558 /* reload_combine uses the information from DF_LIVE_IN,
559 which might still contain registers that have not
560 actually been allocated since they have an
561 equivalence. */
562 gcc_assert (ira_conflicts_p || reload_completed);
563 }
564 else
565 add_to_hard_reg_set (to, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno), r);
566 }
567 }
568
569 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
570 equivalences. */
571
572 static void
573 replace_pseudos_in (rtx *loc, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx usage)
574 {
575 rtx x = *loc;
576 enum rtx_code code;
577 const char *fmt;
578 int i, j;
579
580 if (! x)
581 return;
582
583 code = GET_CODE (x);
584 if (code == REG)
585 {
586 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
587
588 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
589 return;
590
591 x = eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, usage, true, false);
592 if (x != *loc)
593 {
594 *loc = x;
595 replace_pseudos_in (loc, mem_mode, usage);
596 return;
597 }
598
599 if (reg_equiv_constant[regno])
600 *loc = reg_equiv_constant[regno];
601 else if (reg_equiv_invariant[regno])
602 *loc = reg_equiv_invariant[regno];
603 else if (reg_equiv_mem[regno])
604 *loc = reg_equiv_mem[regno];
605 else if (reg_equiv_address[regno])
606 *loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), reg_equiv_address[regno]);
607 else
608 {
609 gcc_assert (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[regno])
610 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != regno);
611 *loc = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
612 }
613
614 return;
615 }
616 else if (code == MEM)
617 {
618 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), usage);
619 return;
620 }
621
622 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
623 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
624 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
625 if (*fmt == 'e')
626 replace_pseudos_in (&XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, usage);
627 else if (*fmt == 'E')
628 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
629 replace_pseudos_in (& XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, usage);
630 }
631
632 /* Determine if the current function has an exception receiver block
633 that reaches the exit block via non-exceptional edges */
634
635 static bool
636 has_nonexceptional_receiver (void)
637 {
638 edge e;
639 edge_iterator ei;
640 basic_block *tos, *worklist, bb;
641
642 /* If we're not optimizing, then just err on the safe side. */
643 if (!optimize)
644 return true;
645
646 /* First determine which blocks can reach exit via normal paths. */
647 tos = worklist = XNEWVEC (basic_block, n_basic_blocks + 1);
648
649 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
650 bb->flags &= ~BB_REACHABLE;
651
652 /* Place the exit block on our worklist. */
653 EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
654 *tos++ = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR;
655
656 /* Iterate: find everything reachable from what we've already seen. */
657 while (tos != worklist)
658 {
659 bb = *--tos;
660
661 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
662 if (!(e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL))
663 {
664 basic_block src = e->src;
665
666 if (!(src->flags & BB_REACHABLE))
667 {
668 src->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
669 *tos++ = src;
670 }
671 }
672 }
673 free (worklist);
674
675 /* Now see if there's a reachable block with an exceptional incoming
676 edge. */
677 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
678 if (bb->flags & BB_REACHABLE)
679 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
680 if (e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL)
681 return true;
682
683 /* No exceptional block reached exit unexceptionally. */
684 return false;
685 }
686
687 \f
688 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
689
690 /* The current basic block while in calculate_elim_costs_all_insns. */
691 static basic_block elim_bb;
692
693 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
694 static int something_needs_elimination;
695 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
696 static int something_needs_operands_changed;
697 /* Set by alter_regs if we spilled a register to the stack. */
698 static bool something_was_spilled;
699
700 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
701 static int failure;
702
703 /* Temporary array of pseudo-register number. */
704 static int *temp_pseudo_reg_arr;
705
706 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
707
708 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
709
710 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
711 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
712 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
713 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
714 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
715
716 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
717 and we must not do any more for this function. */
718
719 int
720 reload (rtx first, int global)
721 {
722 int i, n;
723 rtx insn;
724 struct elim_table *ep;
725 basic_block bb;
726
727 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
728 init_recog ();
729
730 failure = 0;
731
732 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
733
734 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
735 is not something that needs reloading. */
736 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
737
738 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
739 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
740
741 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
742 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
743 clear_secondary_mem ();
744 #endif
745
746 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
747 memset (spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
748 memset (spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
749
750 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
751 are needed. */
752 init_save_areas ();
753
754 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
755 as homes for pseudo registers.
756 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
757 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
758 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
759 mark_home_live (i);
760
761 /* A function that has a nonlocal label that can reach the exit
762 block via non-exceptional paths must save all call-saved
763 registers. */
764 if (cfun->has_nonlocal_label
765 && has_nonexceptional_receiver ())
766 crtl->saves_all_registers = 1;
767
768 if (crtl->saves_all_registers)
769 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
770 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
771 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
772
773 reg_old_renumber = XCNEWVEC (short, max_regno);
774 memcpy (reg_old_renumber, reg_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
775 pseudo_forbidden_regs = XNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
776 pseudo_previous_regs = XCNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
777
778 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
779
780 init_eliminable_invariants (first, true);
781 init_elim_table ();
782
783 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number. Assign
784 stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
785 Do not touch virtual registers. */
786
787 temp_pseudo_reg_arr = XNEWVEC (int, max_regno - LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER - 1);
788 for (n = 0, i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
789 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
790
791 if (ira_conflicts_p)
792 /* Ask IRA to order pseudo-registers for better stack slot
793 sharing. */
794 ira_sort_regnos_for_alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n, reg_max_ref_width);
795
796 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
797 alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr[i], -1, false);
798
799 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
800 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
801 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
802 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
803 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
804 cannot be done. */
805 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
806 if (INSN_P (insn))
807 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
808
809 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
810
811 insns_need_reload = 0;
812 something_needs_elimination = 0;
813
814 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
815 last_spill_reg = -1;
816
817 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
818 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
819 /* There can be multiple ways to eliminate a register;
820 they should be listed adjacently.
821 Elimination for any register fails only if all possible ways fail. */
822 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; )
823 {
824 int from = ep->from;
825 int can_eliminate = 0;
826 do
827 {
828 can_eliminate |= ep->can_eliminate;
829 ep++;
830 }
831 while (ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS] && ep->from == from);
832 if (! can_eliminate)
833 spill_hard_reg (from, 1);
834 }
835
836 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
837 if (frame_pointer_needed)
838 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
839 #endif
840 finish_spills (global);
841
842 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
843 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
844 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
845 reload_in_progress = 1;
846
847 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
848 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
849 for (;;)
850 {
851 int something_changed;
852 int did_spill;
853 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
854
855 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
856 something_was_spilled = false;
857
858 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
859 set_initial_label_offsets ();
860
861 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
862 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
863 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
864 is the normal case.
865
866 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
867 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
868
869 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
870 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
871 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
872 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
873 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
874 valid as an address register.
875
876 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
877 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
878 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
879 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
880 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
881
882 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
883 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
884
885 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
886 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
887 {
888 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], VOIDmode,
889 NULL_RTX);
890
891 if (strict_memory_address_addr_space_p
892 (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), XEXP (x, 0),
893 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x)))
894 reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
895 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
896 || (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
897 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
898 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
899 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
900 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
901 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
902 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
903 reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
904 else
905 {
906 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
907 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
908 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
909 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
910 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
911 the loop. */
912 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
913 reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
914 alter_reg (i, -1, true);
915 }
916 }
917
918 if (caller_save_needed)
919 setup_save_areas ();
920
921 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
922 if (something_was_spilled || starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
923 continue;
924 if (starting_frame_size && crtl->stack_alignment_needed)
925 {
926 /* If we have a stack frame, we must align it now. The
927 stack size may be a part of the offset computation for
928 register elimination. So if this changes the stack size,
929 then repeat the elimination bookkeeping. We don't
930 realign when there is no stack, as that will cause a
931 stack frame when none is needed should
932 STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET not be already aligned to
933 STACK_BOUNDARY. */
934 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, crtl->stack_alignment_needed);
935 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
936 continue;
937 }
938
939 if (caller_save_needed)
940 {
941 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
942 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
943 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
944 }
945
946 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
947
948 if (! ira_conflicts_p)
949 /* Don't do it for IRA. We need this info because we don't
950 change live_throughout and dead_or_set for chains when IRA
951 is used. */
952 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
953
954 did_spill = 0;
955
956 something_changed = 0;
957
958 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
959 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
960 if (something_was_spilled || starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
961 something_changed = 1;
962
963 /* Even if the frame size remained the same, we might still have
964 changed elimination offsets, e.g. if find_reloads called
965 force_const_mem requiring the back end to allocate a constant
966 pool base register that needs to be saved on the stack. */
967 else if (!verify_initial_elim_offsets ())
968 something_changed = 1;
969
970 {
971 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
972 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
973 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
974 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, to_spill);
975
976 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
977 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
978 {
979 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
980 did_spill = 1;
981
982 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
983 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but now can
984 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
985
986 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
987 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
988 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
989 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
990 performed. */
991 something_changed = 1;
992 }
993 }
994
995 select_reload_regs ();
996 if (failure)
997 goto failed;
998
999 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
1000 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
1001
1002 if (! something_changed)
1003 break;
1004
1005 if (caller_save_needed)
1006 delete_caller_save_insns ();
1007
1008 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
1009 }
1010
1011 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
1012 done. */
1013 if (global)
1014 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
1015 if (ep->can_eliminate)
1016 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
1017
1018 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
1019 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
1020 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
1021 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1022 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1023 there and that is incorrect. */
1024
1025 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1026 {
1027 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0)
1028 {
1029 rtx list;
1030 for (list = reg_equiv_init[i]; list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
1031 {
1032 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
1033
1034 /* If we already deleted the insn or if it may trap, we can't
1035 delete it. The latter case shouldn't happen, but can
1036 if an insn has a variable address, gets a REG_EH_REGION
1037 note added to it, and then gets converted into a load
1038 from a constant address. */
1039 if (NOTE_P (equiv_insn)
1040 || can_throw_internal (equiv_insn))
1041 ;
1042 else if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
1043 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1044 else
1045 SET_INSN_DELETED (equiv_insn);
1046 }
1047 }
1048 }
1049
1050 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1051 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1052 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1053
1054 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1055 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1056 {
1057 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1058
1059 reload_as_needed (global);
1060
1061 gcc_assert (old_frame_size == get_frame_size ());
1062
1063 gcc_assert (verify_initial_elim_offsets ());
1064 }
1065
1066 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1067 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1068 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1069 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1070 pseudo. */
1071
1072 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1073 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
1074 bitmap_clear_bit (df_get_live_in (bb), HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1075
1076 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill
1077 regs. */
1078 failed:
1079
1080 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
1081 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1082 reload_in_progress = 0;
1083
1084 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1085 their equivalent memory references.
1086 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1087 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1088
1089 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1090 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1091 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1092 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1093
1094 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1095 {
1096 rtx addr = 0;
1097
1098 if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1099 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);
1100
1101 if (reg_equiv_address[i])
1102 addr = reg_equiv_address[i];
1103
1104 if (addr)
1105 {
1106 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1107 {
1108 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1109
1110 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1111 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1112 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1113 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1114 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (reg, reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1115 else
1116 {
1117 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg) = 0;
1118 MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
1119 }
1120 MEM_NOTRAP_P (reg) = 1;
1121 }
1122 else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1123 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
1124 }
1125
1126 /* We don't want complex addressing modes in debug insns
1127 if simpler ones will do, so delegitimize equivalences
1128 in debug insns. */
1129 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS && reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1130 {
1131 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1132 rtx equiv = 0;
1133 df_ref use, next;
1134
1135 if (reg_equiv_constant[i])
1136 equiv = reg_equiv_constant[i];
1137 else if (reg_equiv_invariant[i])
1138 equiv = reg_equiv_invariant[i];
1139 else if (reg && MEM_P (reg))
1140 equiv = targetm.delegitimize_address (reg);
1141 else if (reg && REG_P (reg) && (int)REGNO (reg) != i)
1142 equiv = reg;
1143
1144 if (equiv == reg)
1145 continue;
1146
1147 for (use = DF_REG_USE_CHAIN (i); use; use = next)
1148 {
1149 insn = DF_REF_INSN (use);
1150
1151 /* Make sure the next ref is for a different instruction,
1152 so that we're not affected by the rescan. */
1153 next = DF_REF_NEXT_REG (use);
1154 while (next && DF_REF_INSN (next) == insn)
1155 next = DF_REF_NEXT_REG (next);
1156
1157 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
1158 {
1159 if (!equiv)
1160 {
1161 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
1162 df_insn_rescan_debug_internal (insn);
1163 }
1164 else
1165 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn)
1166 = simplify_replace_rtx (INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn),
1167 reg, equiv);
1168 }
1169 }
1170 }
1171 }
1172
1173 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1174 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1175 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1176 reload_completed = 1;
1177
1178 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1179 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1180 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns, except those that refer to the return
1181 value and the special mem:BLK CLOBBERs added to prevent the scheduler
1182 from misarranging variable-array code, and simplify (subreg (reg))
1183 operands. Strip and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved
1184 around. */
1185
1186 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1187 if (INSN_P (insn))
1188 {
1189 rtx *pnote;
1190
1191 if (CALL_P (insn))
1192 replace_pseudos_in (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
1193 VOIDmode, CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
1194
1195 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1196 /* We mark with QImode USEs introduced by reload itself. */
1197 && (GET_MODE (insn) == QImode
1198 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX)))
1199 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1200 && (!MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1201 || GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != BLKmode
1202 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)) != SCRATCH
1203 && XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
1204 != stack_pointer_rtx))
1205 && (!REG_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1206 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1207 {
1208 delete_insn (insn);
1209 continue;
1210 }
1211
1212 /* Some CLOBBERs may survive until here and still reference unassigned
1213 pseudos with const equivalent, which may in turn cause ICE in later
1214 passes if the reference remains in place. */
1215 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
1216 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0),
1217 VOIDmode, PATTERN (insn));
1218
1219 /* Discard obvious no-ops, even without -O. This optimization
1220 is fast and doesn't interfere with debugging. */
1221 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
1222 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
1223 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1224 && REG_P (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))
1225 && (REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1226 == REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))))
1227 {
1228 delete_insn (insn);
1229 continue;
1230 }
1231
1232 pnote = &REG_NOTES (insn);
1233 while (*pnote != 0)
1234 {
1235 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1236 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1237 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC)
1238 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1239 else
1240 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1241 }
1242
1243 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1244 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1245 #endif
1246
1247 /* Simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1248 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1249
1250 /* Clean up invalid ASMs so that they don't confuse later passes.
1251 See PR 21299. */
1252 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1253 {
1254 extract_insn (insn);
1255 if (!constrain_operands (1))
1256 {
1257 error_for_asm (insn,
1258 "%<asm%> operand has impossible constraints");
1259 delete_insn (insn);
1260 continue;
1261 }
1262 }
1263 }
1264
1265 /* If we are doing generic stack checking, give a warning if this
1266 function's frame size is larger than we expect. */
1267 if (flag_stack_check == GENERIC_STACK_CHECK)
1268 {
1269 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1270 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1271
1272 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1273 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1274 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1275
1276 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1277 {
1278 warning (0, "frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1279 if (! verbose_warned)
1280 {
1281 warning (0, "try reducing the number of local variables");
1282 verbose_warned = 1;
1283 }
1284 }
1285 }
1286
1287 free (temp_pseudo_reg_arr);
1288
1289 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1290 free_reg_equiv ();
1291 reg_equiv_init = 0;
1292 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1293 free (reg_old_renumber);
1294 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1295 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1296
1297 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1298 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1299 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1300
1301 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1302 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1303 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1304 fixup_abnormal_edges ();
1305
1306 /* Replacing pseudos with their memory equivalents might have
1307 created shared rtx. Subsequent passes would get confused
1308 by this, so unshare everything here. */
1309 unshare_all_rtl_again (first);
1310
1311 #ifdef STACK_BOUNDARY
1312 /* init_emit has set the alignment of the hard frame pointer
1313 to STACK_BOUNDARY. It is very likely no longer valid if
1314 the hard frame pointer was used for register allocation. */
1315 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
1316 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) = BITS_PER_UNIT;
1317 #endif
1318
1319 VEC_free (rtx_p, heap, substitute_stack);
1320
1321 gcc_assert (bitmap_empty_p (&spilled_pseudos));
1322
1323 return failure;
1324 }
1325
1326 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1327 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1328 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1329 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1330 register sets to avoid this.
1331 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1332
1333 static void
1334 maybe_fix_stack_asms (void)
1335 {
1336 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1337 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1338 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1339 struct insn_chain *chain;
1340
1341 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1342 {
1343 int i, noperands;
1344 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1345 rtx pat;
1346
1347 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1348 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1349 continue;
1350 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1351 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1352 continue;
1353
1354 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1355 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1356
1357 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1358 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1359 {
1360 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1361 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1362 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1363 }
1364
1365 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1366 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1367 constraints, operand_mode, NULL);
1368
1369 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1370 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1371 {
1372 const char *p = constraints[i];
1373 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1374 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1375 ALLOWED. */
1376 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1377
1378 for (;;)
1379 {
1380 char c = *p;
1381
1382 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1383 {
1384 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1385 class, and reset the class. */
1386 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1387 cls = NO_REGS;
1388 p++;
1389 if (c == '#')
1390 do {
1391 c = *p++;
1392 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1393 if (c == '\0')
1394 break;
1395 continue;
1396 }
1397
1398 switch (c)
1399 {
1400 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1401 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '<':
1402 case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E': case 'F':
1403 case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I': case 'J':
1404 case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
1405 case TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT:
1406 break;
1407
1408 case 'p':
1409 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1410 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1411 break;
1412
1413 case 'g':
1414 case 'r':
1415 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1416 break;
1417
1418 default:
1419 if (EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (c, p))
1420 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1421 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1422 else
1423 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1424 [(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (c, p)];
1425 }
1426 p += CONSTRAINT_LEN (c, p);
1427 }
1428 }
1429 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1430 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1431 out of the life information. */
1432 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1433 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1434 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1435 {
1436 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1437 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1438 }
1439 }
1440
1441 #endif
1442 }
1443 \f
1444 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1445 of CHAIN. */
1446 static void
1447 copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *chain)
1448 {
1449 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1450 chain->rld = XOBNEWVEC (&reload_obstack, struct reload, n_reloads);
1451 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1452 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1453 }
1454
1455 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1456 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1457 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1458 static void
1459 calculate_needs_all_insns (int global)
1460 {
1461 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1462 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1463
1464 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1465
1466 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1467 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1468 {
1469 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1470
1471 next = chain->next;
1472
1473 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1474 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1475 chain->need_elim = 0;
1476 chain->need_reload = 0;
1477 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1478
1479 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1480 include REG_LABEL_OPERAND and REG_LABEL_TARGET), we need to see
1481 what effects this has on the known offsets at labels. */
1482
1483 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn)
1484 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1485 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1486
1487 if (INSN_P (insn))
1488 {
1489 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1490 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1491 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1492 int did_elimination = 0;
1493 int operands_changed = 0;
1494 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1495
1496 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1497 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1498 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1499 && (reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]
1500 || (reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]))
1501 && reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])
1502 continue;
1503
1504 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1505 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1506 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1507
1508 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1509 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1510 global, spill_reg_order);
1511
1512 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1513 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1514 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1515 anyway, so discard it now.
1516 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1517 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1518 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1519 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1520 {
1521 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1522 if (set
1523 &&
1524 ((SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1525 && REG_P (SET_SRC (set))
1526 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1527 || (REG_P (SET_SRC (set)) && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1528 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] < 0
1529 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1530 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] != NULL
1531 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] != NULL
1532 && rtx_equal_p (reg_equiv_memory_loc
1533 [REGNO (SET_SRC (set))],
1534 reg_equiv_memory_loc
1535 [REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]))))
1536 {
1537 if (ira_conflicts_p)
1538 /* Inform IRA about the insn deletion. */
1539 ira_mark_memory_move_deletion (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)),
1540 REGNO (SET_SRC (set)));
1541 delete_insn (insn);
1542 /* Delete it from the reload chain. */
1543 if (chain->prev)
1544 chain->prev->next = next;
1545 else
1546 reload_insn_chain = next;
1547 if (next)
1548 next->prev = chain->prev;
1549 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1550 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1551 continue;
1552 }
1553 }
1554 if (num_eliminable)
1555 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1556
1557 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1558 register eliminations. */
1559 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1560 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1561 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1562
1563 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1564 if (did_elimination)
1565 {
1566 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1567 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1568 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1569 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1570 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1571 }
1572
1573 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1574
1575 if (n_reloads != 0)
1576 {
1577 copy_reloads (chain);
1578 *pprev_reload = chain;
1579 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1580 }
1581 }
1582 }
1583 *pprev_reload = 0;
1584 }
1585 \f
1586 /* This function is called from the register allocator to set up estimates
1587 for the cost of eliminating pseudos which have REG_EQUIV equivalences to
1588 an invariant. The structure is similar to calculate_needs_all_insns. */
1589
1590 void
1591 calculate_elim_costs_all_insns (void)
1592 {
1593 int *reg_equiv_init_cost;
1594 basic_block bb;
1595 int i;
1596
1597 reg_equiv_init_cost = XCNEWVEC (int, max_regno);
1598 init_elim_table ();
1599 init_eliminable_invariants (get_insns (), false);
1600
1601 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
1602 set_initial_label_offsets ();
1603
1604 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
1605 {
1606 rtx insn;
1607 elim_bb = bb;
1608
1609 FOR_BB_INSNS (bb, insn)
1610 {
1611 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1612 include REG_LABEL_OPERAND and REG_LABEL_TARGET), we need to see
1613 what effects this has on the known offsets at labels. */
1614
1615 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn)
1616 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1617 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1618
1619 if (INSN_P (insn))
1620 {
1621 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1622
1623 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1624 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1625 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1626 && (reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]
1627 || (reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])))
1628 {
1629 unsigned regno = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
1630 rtx init = reg_equiv_init[regno];
1631 if (init)
1632 {
1633 rtx t = eliminate_regs_1 (SET_SRC (set), VOIDmode, insn,
1634 false, true);
1635 int cost = rtx_cost (t, SET,
1636 optimize_bb_for_speed_p (bb));
1637 int freq = REG_FREQ_FROM_BB (bb);
1638
1639 reg_equiv_init_cost[regno] = cost * freq;
1640 continue;
1641 }
1642 }
1643 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1644 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1645 elimination_costs_in_insn (insn);
1646
1647 if (num_eliminable)
1648 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1649 }
1650 }
1651 }
1652 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1653 {
1654 if (reg_equiv_invariant[i])
1655 {
1656 if (reg_equiv_init[i])
1657 {
1658 int cost = reg_equiv_init_cost[i];
1659 if (dump_file)
1660 fprintf (dump_file,
1661 "Reg %d has equivalence, initial gains %d\n", i, cost);
1662 if (cost != 0)
1663 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (i, cost);
1664 }
1665 else
1666 {
1667 if (dump_file)
1668 fprintf (dump_file,
1669 "Reg %d had equivalence, but can't be eliminated\n",
1670 i);
1671 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (i, 0);
1672 }
1673 }
1674 }
1675
1676 free_reg_equiv ();
1677 free (reg_equiv_init_cost);
1678 }
1679 \f
1680 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1681 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1682
1683 static int
1684 reload_reg_class_lower (const void *r1p, const void *r2p)
1685 {
1686 int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1687 int t;
1688
1689 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1690 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1691 if (t != 0)
1692 return t;
1693
1694 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1695 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].rclass] == 1)
1696 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].rclass] == 1));
1697 if (t != 0)
1698 return t;
1699
1700 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1701 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1702 if (t != 0)
1703 return t;
1704
1705 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1706 t = (int) rld[r1].rclass - (int) rld[r2].rclass;
1707 if (t != 0)
1708 return t;
1709
1710 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1711 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1712 return r1 - r2;
1713 }
1714 \f
1715 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1716 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1717
1718 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1719 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1720 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1721 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1722
1723 /* Map of hard regno to pseudo regno currently occupying the hard
1724 reg. */
1725 static int hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1726
1727 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1728
1729 static void
1730 count_pseudo (int reg)
1731 {
1732 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1733 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1734 int nregs;
1735
1736 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1737 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1738 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA
1739 is used. */
1740 || (ira_conflicts_p && r < 0))
1741 return;
1742
1743 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1744
1745 gcc_assert (r >= 0);
1746
1747 spill_add_cost[r] += freq;
1748 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1749 while (nregs-- > 0)
1750 {
1751 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = reg;
1752 spill_cost[r + nregs] += freq;
1753 }
1754 }
1755
1756 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1757 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1758
1759 static void
1760 order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *chain)
1761 {
1762 unsigned i;
1763 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1764 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1765 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1766
1767 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1768
1769 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1770 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1771 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1772 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[i] = -1;
1773
1774 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1775 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1776 that are live in or across this insn. */
1777
1778 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1779 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1780 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1781 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1782
1783 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1784 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1785 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1786
1787 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1788 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1789 {
1790 count_pseudo (i);
1791 }
1792 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1793 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1794 {
1795 count_pseudo (i);
1796 }
1797 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1798 }
1799 \f
1800 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1801 be processed. */
1802 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1803
1804 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1805 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1806
1807 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1808 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1809 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1810 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1811
1812 static void
1813 count_spilled_pseudo (int spilled, int spilled_nregs, int reg)
1814 {
1815 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1816 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1817 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1818
1819 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA is
1820 used. */
1821 if ((ira_conflicts_p && r < 0)
1822 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1823 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1824 return;
1825
1826 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1827
1828 spill_add_cost[r] -= freq;
1829 while (nregs-- > 0)
1830 {
1831 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = -1;
1832 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= freq;
1833 }
1834 }
1835
1836 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1837
1838 static int
1839 find_reg (struct insn_chain *chain, int order)
1840 {
1841 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1842 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1843 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1844 int best_reg = -1;
1845 unsigned int i, j, n;
1846 int k;
1847 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1848 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1849 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1850 static int regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1851 static int best_regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1852
1853 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1854 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1855 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->rclass]);
1856
1857 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1858 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1859 {
1860 int other = reload_order[k];
1861
1862 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1863 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1864 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1865 }
1866
1867 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1868 {
1869 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1870 unsigned int regno = reg_alloc_order[i];
1871 #else
1872 unsigned int regno = i;
1873 #endif
1874
1875 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1876 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1877 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1878 {
1879 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1880 int ok = 1;
1881 unsigned int this_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rl->mode];
1882
1883 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1884 {
1885 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1886 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1887 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1888 ok = 0;
1889 }
1890 if (! ok)
1891 continue;
1892
1893 if (ira_conflicts_p)
1894 {
1895 /* Ask IRA to find a better pseudo-register for
1896 spilling. */
1897 for (n = j = 0; j < this_nregs; j++)
1898 {
1899 int r = hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[regno + j];
1900
1901 if (r < 0)
1902 continue;
1903 if (n == 0 || regno_pseudo_regs[n - 1] != r)
1904 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = r;
1905 }
1906 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = -1;
1907 if (best_reg < 0
1908 || ira_better_spill_reload_regno_p (regno_pseudo_regs,
1909 best_regno_pseudo_regs,
1910 rl->in, rl->out,
1911 chain->insn))
1912 {
1913 best_reg = regno;
1914 for (j = 0;; j++)
1915 {
1916 best_regno_pseudo_regs[j] = regno_pseudo_regs[j];
1917 if (regno_pseudo_regs[j] < 0)
1918 break;
1919 }
1920 }
1921 continue;
1922 }
1923
1924 if (rl->in && REG_P (rl->in) && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1925 this_cost--;
1926 if (rl->out && REG_P (rl->out) && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1927 this_cost--;
1928 if (this_cost < best_cost
1929 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1930 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1931 || (this_cost == best_cost
1932 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1933 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1934 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1935 #else
1936 && call_used_regs[regno]
1937 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1938 #endif
1939 ))
1940 {
1941 best_reg = regno;
1942 best_cost = this_cost;
1943 }
1944 }
1945 }
1946 if (best_reg == -1)
1947 return 0;
1948
1949 if (dump_file)
1950 fprintf (dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1951
1952 rl->nregs = hard_regno_nregs[best_reg][rl->mode];
1953 rl->regno = best_reg;
1954
1955 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1956 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1957 {
1958 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1959 }
1960
1961 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1962 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1963 {
1964 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1965 }
1966
1967 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1968 {
1969 gcc_assert (spill_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1970 gcc_assert (spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1971 gcc_assert (hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[best_reg + i] == -1);
1972 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1973 }
1974 return 1;
1975 }
1976
1977 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1978 is given by CHAIN.
1979 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1980 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1981 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
1985 {
1986 int i;
1987
1988 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1989 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1990 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1991 that provided the reload registers. */
1992 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1993 {
1994 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1995 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1996 {
1997 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1998 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1999 chain->rld[i].nregs
2000 = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)];
2001 }
2002 else
2003 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
2004 reload_order[i] = i;
2005 }
2006
2007 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
2008 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
2009
2010 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
2011
2012 if (dump_file)
2013 fprintf (dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
2014
2015 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
2016
2017 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
2018
2019 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
2020
2021 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
2022 {
2023 int r = reload_order[i];
2024
2025 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
2026 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
2027 && ! rld[r].optional
2028 && rld[r].regno == -1)
2029 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
2030 {
2031 if (dump_file)
2032 fprintf (dump_file, "reload failure for reload %d\n", r);
2033 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].rclass);
2034 failure = 1;
2035 return;
2036 }
2037 }
2038
2039 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2040 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2041
2042 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
2043 }
2044
2045 static void
2046 select_reload_regs (void)
2047 {
2048 struct insn_chain *chain;
2049
2050 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
2051 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
2052 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
2053 find_reload_regs (chain);
2054 }
2055 \f
2056 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
2057 this iteration. */
2058 static void
2059 delete_caller_save_insns (void)
2060 {
2061 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
2062
2063 while (c != 0)
2064 {
2065 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
2066 {
2067 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
2068 rtx insn = c->insn;
2069
2070 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
2071 reload_insn_chain = next;
2072 delete_insn (insn);
2073
2074 if (next)
2075 next->prev = c->prev;
2076 if (c->prev)
2077 c->prev->next = next;
2078 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
2079 unused_insn_chains = c;
2080 c = next;
2081 }
2082 if (c != 0)
2083 c = c->next;
2084 }
2085 }
2086 \f
2087 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
2088 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
2089
2090 static void
2091 spill_failure (rtx insn, enum reg_class rclass)
2092 {
2093 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
2094 error_for_asm (insn, "can't find a register in class %qs while "
2095 "reloading %<asm%>",
2096 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2097 else
2098 {
2099 error ("unable to find a register to spill in class %qs",
2100 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2101
2102 if (dump_file)
2103 {
2104 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
2105 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
2106 }
2107 fatal_insn ("this is the insn:", insn);
2108 }
2109 }
2110 \f
2111 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
2112 data that is dead in INSN. */
2113
2114 static void
2115 delete_dead_insn (rtx insn)
2116 {
2117 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
2118 rtx prev_dest;
2119
2120 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
2121 too. */
2122 if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
2123 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), REG_P (prev_dest))
2124 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
2125 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
2126 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
2127 delete_dead_insn (prev);
2128
2129 SET_INSN_DELETED (insn);
2130 }
2131
2132 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
2133 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
2134
2135 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
2136 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
2137 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
2138 can share one stack slot. */
2139
2140 static void
2141 alter_reg (int i, int from_reg, bool dont_share_p)
2142 {
2143 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
2144 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
2145 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
2146 return;
2147
2148 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
2149 ignore it. */
2150 if (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
2151 return;
2152
2153 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
2154 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
2155 SET_REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i],
2156 reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i);
2157
2158 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
2159 allocate a stack slot for it. */
2160
2161 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
2162 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
2163 && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
2164 && (reg_equiv_invariant[i] == 0 || reg_equiv_init[i] == 0)
2165 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
2166 {
2167 rtx x = NULL_RTX;
2168 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2169 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
2170 unsigned int inherent_align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
2171 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
2172 unsigned int min_align = reg_max_ref_width[i] * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2173 int adjust = 0;
2174
2175 something_was_spilled = true;
2176
2177 if (ira_conflicts_p)
2178 {
2179 /* Mark the spill for IRA. */
2180 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
2181 if (!dont_share_p)
2182 x = ira_reuse_stack_slot (i, inherent_size, total_size);
2183 }
2184
2185 if (x)
2186 ;
2187
2188 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
2189 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
2190 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
2191
2192 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
2193 enough inherent space and enough total space.
2194 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
2195 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
2196 else if (from_reg == -1 || (!dont_share_p && ira_conflicts_p))
2197 {
2198 rtx stack_slot;
2199
2200 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
2201 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2202 min_align > inherent_align
2203 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2204
2205 stack_slot = x;
2206
2207 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2208 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2209 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2210 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2211 {
2212 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
2213 if (adjust)
2214 stack_slot
2215 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2216 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2217 MODE_INT, 1),
2218 adjust);
2219 }
2220
2221 if (! dont_share_p && ira_conflicts_p)
2222 /* Inform IRA about allocation a new stack slot. */
2223 ira_mark_new_stack_slot (stack_slot, i, total_size);
2224 }
2225
2226 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
2227 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
2228 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
2229 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2230 >= inherent_size)
2231 && MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) >= min_align)
2232 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
2233
2234 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2235 else
2236 {
2237 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2238 and for total size. */
2239 rtx stack_slot;
2240
2241 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2242 {
2243 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2244 > inherent_size)
2245 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2246 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
2247 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
2248 if (MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) > min_align)
2249 min_align = MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2250 }
2251
2252 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2253 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2254 min_align > inherent_align
2255 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2256 stack_slot = x;
2257
2258 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2259 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2260 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2261 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2262 {
2263 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
2264 if (adjust)
2265 stack_slot
2266 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2267 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2268 MODE_INT, 1),
2269 adjust);
2270 }
2271
2272 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
2273 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
2274 }
2275
2276 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2277 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2278 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
2279 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
2280
2281 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2282 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2283 x = adjust_address_nv (x, GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), adjust);
2284
2285 /* Set all of the memory attributes as appropriate for a spill. */
2286 set_mem_attrs_for_spill (x);
2287
2288 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2289 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
2290 }
2291 }
2292
2293 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs used by
2294 pseudo-reg number REGNO, accessed in MODE. */
2295
2296 static void
2297 mark_home_live_1 (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
2298 {
2299 int i, lim;
2300
2301 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2302 if (i < 0)
2303 return;
2304 lim = end_hard_regno (mode, i);
2305 while (i < lim)
2306 df_set_regs_ever_live(i++, true);
2307 }
2308
2309 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2310 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2311
2312 void
2313 mark_home_live (int regno)
2314 {
2315 if (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0)
2316 mark_home_live_1 (regno, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
2317 }
2318 \f
2319 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2320
2321 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2322
2323 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2324
2325 INITIAL_P is nonzero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2326 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2327 current offset. */
2328
2329 static void
2330 set_label_offsets (rtx x, rtx insn, int initial_p)
2331 {
2332 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2333 rtx tem;
2334 unsigned int i;
2335 struct elim_table *p;
2336
2337 switch (code)
2338 {
2339 case LABEL_REF:
2340 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2341 return;
2342
2343 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2344
2345 /* ... fall through ... */
2346
2347 case CODE_LABEL:
2348 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2349 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2350 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2351 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2352 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2353 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2354
2355 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num])
2356 {
2357 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2358 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2359 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2360 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2361 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num] = 1;
2362 }
2363
2364 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2365 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2366 that label. */
2367
2368 else if (x == insn
2369 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2370 && BARRIER_P (tem))
2371 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2372 else
2373 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2374 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2375 where the offsets disagree. */
2376
2377 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2378 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2379 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2380 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2381 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2382
2383 return;
2384
2385 case JUMP_INSN:
2386 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2387
2388 /* ... fall through ... */
2389
2390 case INSN:
2391 case CALL_INSN:
2392 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL_OPERAND notes can be branched
2393 to indirectly and hence must have all eliminations at their
2394 initial offsets. */
2395 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2396 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL_OPERAND)
2397 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2398 return;
2399
2400 case PARALLEL:
2401 case ADDR_VEC:
2402 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2403 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2404 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2405 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2406
2407 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2408 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2409 insn, initial_p);
2410 return;
2411
2412 case SET:
2413 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2414 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2415 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2416 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2417 call ourselves recursively.
2418
2419 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2420 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2421 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2422 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2423 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2424
2425 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2426 return;
2427
2428 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2429 {
2430 case PC:
2431 case RETURN:
2432 return;
2433
2434 case LABEL_REF:
2435 set_label_offsets (SET_SRC (x), insn, initial_p);
2436 return;
2437
2438 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2439 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2440 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2441 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2442 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2443 break;
2444
2445 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2446 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2447 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2448 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2449 break;
2450 return;
2451
2452 default:
2453 break;
2454 }
2455
2456 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2457 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2458 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2459 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2460 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2461 break;
2462
2463 default:
2464 break;
2465 }
2466 }
2467 \f
2468 /* Called through for_each_rtx, this function examines every reg that occurs
2469 in PX and adjusts the costs for its elimination which are gathered by IRA.
2470 DATA is the insn in which PX occurs. We do not recurse into MEM
2471 expressions. */
2472
2473 static int
2474 note_reg_elim_costly (rtx *px, void *data)
2475 {
2476 rtx insn = (rtx)data;
2477 rtx x = *px;
2478
2479 if (MEM_P (x))
2480 return -1;
2481
2482 if (REG_P (x)
2483 && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2484 && reg_equiv_init[REGNO (x)]
2485 && reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (x)])
2486 {
2487 rtx t = reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (x)];
2488 rtx new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (t, Pmode, insn, true, true);
2489 int cost = rtx_cost (new_rtx, SET, optimize_bb_for_speed_p (elim_bb));
2490 int freq = REG_FREQ_FROM_BB (elim_bb);
2491
2492 if (cost != 0)
2493 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (REGNO (x), -cost * freq);
2494 }
2495 return 0;
2496 }
2497
2498 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2499 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2500
2501 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2502 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2503 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2504 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2505 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2506
2507 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2508 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is nonzero, write a
2509 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2510 the REG is being modified.
2511
2512 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2513 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2514 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2515 is outside of MEMs.
2516
2517 If FOR_COSTS is true, we are being called before reload in order to
2518 estimate the costs of keeping registers with an equivalence unallocated.
2519
2520 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2521 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2522 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2523 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2524 the proper thing. */
2525
2526 static rtx
2527 eliminate_regs_1 (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn,
2528 bool may_use_invariant, bool for_costs)
2529 {
2530 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2531 struct elim_table *ep;
2532 int regno;
2533 rtx new_rtx;
2534 int i, j;
2535 const char *fmt;
2536 int copied = 0;
2537
2538 if (! current_function_decl)
2539 return x;
2540
2541 switch (code)
2542 {
2543 case CONST_INT:
2544 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2545 case CONST_FIXED:
2546 case CONST_VECTOR:
2547 case CONST:
2548 case SYMBOL_REF:
2549 case CODE_LABEL:
2550 case PC:
2551 case CC0:
2552 case ASM_INPUT:
2553 case ADDR_VEC:
2554 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2555 case RETURN:
2556 return x;
2557
2558 case REG:
2559 regno = REGNO (x);
2560
2561 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2562 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2563 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2564 {
2565 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2566 ep++)
2567 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2568 return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2569
2570 }
2571 else if (reg_renumber && reg_renumber[regno] < 0
2572 && reg_equiv_invariant && reg_equiv_invariant[regno])
2573 {
2574 if (may_use_invariant || (insn && DEBUG_INSN_P (insn)))
2575 return eliminate_regs_1 (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_invariant[regno]),
2576 mem_mode, insn, true, for_costs);
2577 /* There exists at least one use of REGNO that cannot be
2578 eliminated. Prevent the defining insn from being deleted. */
2579 reg_equiv_init[regno] = NULL_RTX;
2580 if (!for_costs)
2581 alter_reg (regno, -1, true);
2582 }
2583 return x;
2584
2585 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2586 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2587 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2588
2589 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2590 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2591
2592 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2593 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (IA-32,
2594 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2595 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2596
2597 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2598 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2599 case PLUS:
2600 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2601 the sum. */
2602 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2603 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2604 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2605 {
2606 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2607 ep++)
2608 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2609 {
2610 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2611 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2612 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2613 to do so at other times because that would change the
2614 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2615 We special-case the commonest situation in
2616 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2617 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2618 if (mem_mode != 0 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
2619 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2620 return ep->to_rtx;
2621 else
2622 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2623 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
2624 ep->previous_offset));
2625 }
2626
2627 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2628 operand is a constant. */
2629 return x;
2630 }
2631
2632 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2633 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2634 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2635
2636 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2637 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2638 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2639 operand of a load-address insn. */
2640
2641 {
2642 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true,
2643 for_costs);
2644 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2645 for_costs);
2646
2647 if (reg_renumber && (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1)))
2648 {
2649 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2650 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2651 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2652 be in the position of any operand. */
2653 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && REG_P (new1)
2654 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2655 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2656 && reg_equiv_constant != 0
2657 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
2658 new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
2659 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && REG_P (new0)
2660 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2661 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2662 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
2663 new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];
2664
2665 new_rtx = form_sum (GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2666
2667 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2668 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2669 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2670 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new_rtx) != PLUS)
2671 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, const0_rtx);
2672 else
2673 return new_rtx;
2674 }
2675 }
2676 return x;
2677
2678 case MULT:
2679 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2680 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2681 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2682 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2683 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2684 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2685 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2686 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2687 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2688 ep++)
2689 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2690 {
2691 if (! mem_mode
2692 /* Refs inside notes or in DEBUG_INSNs don't count for
2693 this purpose. */
2694 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2695 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST
2696 || DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))))
2697 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2698
2699 return
2700 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2701 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2702 }
2703
2704 /* ... fall through ... */
2705
2706 case CALL:
2707 case COMPARE:
2708 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2709 case MINUS:
2710 case DIV: case UDIV:
2711 case MOD: case UMOD:
2712 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2713 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2714 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2715 case NE: case EQ:
2716 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2717 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2718 {
2719 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false,
2720 for_costs);
2721 rtx new1 = XEXP (x, 1)
2722 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, false,
2723 for_costs) : 0;
2724
2725 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2726 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2727 }
2728 return x;
2729
2730 case EXPR_LIST:
2731 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2732 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2733 {
2734 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true,
2735 for_costs);
2736 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2737 {
2738 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2739 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2740 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2741 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_DEAD)
2742 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2743 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2744 for_costs)
2745 : NULL_RTX);
2746
2747 x = alloc_reg_note (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new_rtx, XEXP (x, 1));
2748 }
2749 }
2750
2751 /* ... fall through ... */
2752
2753 case INSN_LIST:
2754 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2755 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2756 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2757 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2758 {
2759 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2760 for_costs);
2761 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 1))
2762 return
2763 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx);
2764 }
2765 return x;
2766
2767 case PRE_INC:
2768 case POST_INC:
2769 case PRE_DEC:
2770 case POST_DEC:
2771 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2772 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2773 happen. */
2774 return x;
2775
2776 case PRE_MODIFY:
2777 case POST_MODIFY:
2778 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2779 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2780 happen. The only remaining case we need to consider here is
2781 that the increment value may be an eliminable register. */
2782 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2783 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0) == XEXP (x, 0))
2784 {
2785 rtx new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1), mem_mode,
2786 insn, true, for_costs);
2787
2788 if (new_rtx != XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1))
2789 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
2790 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x),
2791 XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx));
2792 }
2793 return x;
2794
2795 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2796 case NEG: case NOT:
2797 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2798 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2799 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2800 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2801 case ABS:
2802 case SQRT:
2803 case FFS:
2804 case CLZ:
2805 case CTZ:
2806 case POPCOUNT:
2807 case PARITY:
2808 case BSWAP:
2809 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false,
2810 for_costs);
2811 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2812 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2813 return x;
2814
2815 case SUBREG:
2816 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2817 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2818 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2819 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2820 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reload
2821 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2822 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2823 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2824 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2825 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2826 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2827 {
2828 new_rtx = SUBREG_REG (x);
2829 }
2830 else
2831 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn, false,
2832 for_costs);
2833
2834 if (new_rtx != SUBREG_REG (x))
2835 {
2836 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2837 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new_rtx));
2838
2839 if (MEM_P (new_rtx)
2840 && ((x_size < new_size
2841 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2842 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2843 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2844 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2845 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2846 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2847 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2848 subreg so that push_reload can see it. */
2849 && ! ((x_size - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2850 == (new_size -1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2851 #endif
2852 )
2853 || x_size == new_size)
2854 )
2855 return adjust_address_nv (new_rtx, GET_MODE (x), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2856 else
2857 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2858 }
2859
2860 return x;
2861
2862 case MEM:
2863 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2864 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2865 case more efficiently. */
2866
2867 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), insn, true,
2868 for_costs);
2869 if (for_costs
2870 && memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
2871 && !memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx))
2872 for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), note_reg_elim_costly, insn);
2873
2874 return replace_equiv_address_nv (x, new_rtx);
2875
2876 case USE:
2877 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2878 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), VOIDmode, insn, false,
2879 for_costs);
2880 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2881 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2882 return x;
2883
2884 case CLOBBER:
2885 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2886 gcc_assert (insn && DEBUG_INSN_P (insn));
2887 break;
2888
2889 case SET:
2890 gcc_unreachable ();
2891
2892 default:
2893 break;
2894 }
2895
2896 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2897 copy of the rtx. */
2898 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2899 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2900 {
2901 if (*fmt == 'e')
2902 {
2903 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn, false,
2904 for_costs);
2905 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2906 {
2907 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2908 copied = 1;
2909 }
2910 XEXP (x, i) = new_rtx;
2911 }
2912 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2913 {
2914 int copied_vec = 0;
2915 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2916 {
2917 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn, false,
2918 for_costs);
2919 if (new_rtx != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2920 {
2921 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2922 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2923 if (! copied)
2924 {
2925 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2926 copied = 1;
2927 }
2928 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2929 copied_vec = 1;
2930 }
2931 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new_rtx;
2932 }
2933 }
2934 }
2935
2936 return x;
2937 }
2938
2939 rtx
2940 eliminate_regs (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn)
2941 {
2942 return eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, insn, false, false);
2943 }
2944
2945 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2946 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2947 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2948
2949 static void
2950 elimination_effects (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode)
2951 {
2952 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2953 struct elim_table *ep;
2954 int regno;
2955 int i, j;
2956 const char *fmt;
2957
2958 switch (code)
2959 {
2960 case CONST_INT:
2961 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2962 case CONST_FIXED:
2963 case CONST_VECTOR:
2964 case CONST:
2965 case SYMBOL_REF:
2966 case CODE_LABEL:
2967 case PC:
2968 case CC0:
2969 case ASM_INPUT:
2970 case ADDR_VEC:
2971 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2972 case RETURN:
2973 return;
2974
2975 case REG:
2976 regno = REGNO (x);
2977
2978 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2979 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2980 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2981 {
2982 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2983 ep++)
2984 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2985 {
2986 if (! mem_mode)
2987 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2988 return;
2989 }
2990
2991 }
2992 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2993 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2994 && ! function_invariant_p (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2995 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant[regno], mem_mode);
2996 return;
2997
2998 case PRE_INC:
2999 case POST_INC:
3000 case PRE_DEC:
3001 case POST_DEC:
3002 case POST_MODIFY:
3003 case PRE_MODIFY:
3004 /* If we modify the source of an elimination rule, disable it. */
3005 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3006 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3007 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3008
3009 /* If we modify the target of an elimination rule by adding a constant,
3010 update its offset. If we modify the target in any other way, we'll
3011 have to disable the rule as well. */
3012 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3013 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3014 {
3015 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
3016
3017 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
3018 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3019 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
3020 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
3021 #endif
3022 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3023 ep->offset += size;
3024 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
3025 ep->offset -= size;
3026 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3027 {
3028 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
3029 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
3030 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
3031 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
3032 else
3033 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3034 }
3035 }
3036
3037 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
3038 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
3039 break;
3040
3041 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
3042 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
3043 case NEG: case NOT:
3044 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
3045 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
3046 case FLOAT: case FIX:
3047 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
3048 case ABS:
3049 case SQRT:
3050 case FFS:
3051 case CLZ:
3052 case CTZ:
3053 case POPCOUNT:
3054 case PARITY:
3055 case BSWAP:
3056 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3057 return;
3058
3059 case SUBREG:
3060 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
3061 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
3062 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
3063 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
3064 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
3065 return;
3066
3067 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
3068 return;
3069
3070 case USE:
3071 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
3072 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
3073 know how this register is used. */
3074 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3075 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3076 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3077
3078 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3079 return;
3080
3081 case CLOBBER:
3082 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
3083 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
3084 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
3085 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3086 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3087 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3088
3089 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3090 return;
3091
3092 case SET:
3093 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3094 if (REG_P (SET_DEST (x)))
3095 {
3096 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
3097 elimination.
3098
3099 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
3100 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
3101 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
3102 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
3103 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
3104 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
3105 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
3106
3107 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3108 ep++)
3109 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
3110 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3111 {
3112 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
3113 this elimination can't be done. */
3114 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
3115
3116 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
3117 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
3118 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
3119 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
3120 else
3121 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3122 }
3123 }
3124
3125 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), VOIDmode);
3126 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), VOIDmode);
3127 return;
3128
3129 case MEM:
3130 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
3131 recursive call. */
3132 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
3133 return;
3134
3135 default:
3136 break;
3137 }
3138
3139 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3140 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3141 {
3142 if (*fmt == 'e')
3143 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
3144 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3145 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3146 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
3147 }
3148 }
3149
3150 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
3151 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
3152 eliminable. */
3153
3154 static void
3155 check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx x)
3156 {
3157 const char *fmt;
3158 int i;
3159 enum rtx_code code;
3160
3161 if (x == 0)
3162 return;
3163
3164 code = GET_CODE (x);
3165
3166 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3167 {
3168 struct elim_table *ep;
3169
3170 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3171 if (ep->from_rtx == x)
3172 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3173 return;
3174 }
3175
3176 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3177 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3178 {
3179 if (*fmt == 'e')
3180 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
3181 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3182 {
3183 int j;
3184 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3185 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3186 }
3187 }
3188 }
3189 \f
3190 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
3191
3192 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
3193 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
3194
3195 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
3196
3197 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
3198 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
3199 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
3200 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
3201 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
3202
3203 static int
3204 eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx insn, int replace)
3205 {
3206 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
3207 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
3208 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
3209 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
3210 rtx new_body;
3211 int val = 0;
3212 int i;
3213 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3214 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3215 struct elim_table *ep;
3216 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
3217
3218 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
3219 {
3220 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3221 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
3222 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
3223 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
3224 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT
3225 || DEBUG_INSN_P (insn));
3226 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3227 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn)
3228 = eliminate_regs (INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn), VOIDmode, insn);
3229 return 0;
3230 }
3231
3232 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3233 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3234 {
3235 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
3236 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3237 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
3238 {
3239 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3240 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
3241 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
3242 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
3243 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
3244 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
3245 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3246 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3247 {
3248 rtx base = SET_SRC (old_set);
3249 rtx base_insn = insn;
3250 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
3251
3252 while (base != ep->to_rtx)
3253 {
3254 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
3255
3256 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS
3257 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (base, 1)))
3258 {
3259 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
3260 base = XEXP (base, 0);
3261 }
3262 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (base_insn)) != 0
3263 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
3264 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), base))
3265 {
3266 base = SET_SRC (prev_set);
3267 base_insn = prev_insn;
3268 }
3269 else
3270 break;
3271 }
3272
3273 if (base == ep->to_rtx)
3274 {
3275 rtx src
3276 = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);
3277
3278 new_body = old_body;
3279 if (! replace)
3280 {
3281 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3282 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3283 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3284 }
3285 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3286 old_set = single_set (insn);
3287
3288 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
3289 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
3290 the same and let reload fit it up. */
3291 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
3292 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
3293 ep->to_rtx, 1);
3294 if (! apply_change_group ())
3295 {
3296 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
3297 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
3298 }
3299
3300 val = 1;
3301 goto done;
3302 }
3303 }
3304 #endif
3305
3306 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3307 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3308 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3309
3310 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3311 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3312 if (replace)
3313 {
3314 delete_dead_insn (insn);
3315 return 1;
3316 }
3317 val = 1;
3318 goto done;
3319 }
3320 }
3321
3322 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3323 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3324 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3325 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3326 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3327 {
3328 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3329 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3330 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3331 if (plus_src
3332 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3333 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3334 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3335 || plus_src)
3336 {
3337 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3338 (plus (...) CST). */
3339 rtx links;
3340 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3341 {
3342 if ((REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3343 || REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUIV)
3344 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3345 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)))
3346 {
3347 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3348 break;
3349 }
3350 }
3351 }
3352
3353 /* Check that the first operand of the PLUS is a hard reg or
3354 the lowpart subreg of one. */
3355 if (plus_cst_src)
3356 {
3357 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3358 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (reg))
3359 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3360
3361 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3362 plus_cst_src = 0;
3363 }
3364 }
3365 if (plus_cst_src)
3366 {
3367 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3368 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 1));
3369
3370 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
3371 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3372
3373 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3374 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
3375 {
3376 rtx to_rtx = ep->to_rtx;
3377 offset += ep->offset;
3378 offset = trunc_int_for_mode (offset, GET_MODE (plus_cst_src));
3379
3380 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)) == SUBREG)
3381 to_rtx = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)),
3382 to_rtx);
3383 /* If we have a nonzero offset, and the source is already
3384 a simple REG, the following transformation would
3385 increase the cost of the insn by replacing a simple REG
3386 with (plus (reg sp) CST). So try only when we already
3387 had a PLUS before. */
3388 if (offset == 0 || plus_src)
3389 {
3390 rtx new_src = plus_constant (to_rtx, offset);
3391
3392 new_body = old_body;
3393 if (! replace)
3394 {
3395 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3396 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3397 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3398 }
3399 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3400 old_set = single_set (insn);
3401
3402 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we make the
3403 change. If not, try to replace the whole pattern with
3404 a simple set (this may help if the original insn was a
3405 PARALLEL that was only recognized as single_set due to
3406 REG_UNUSED notes). If this isn't valid either, keep
3407 the INSN_CODE the same and let reload fix it up. */
3408 if (!validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), new_src, 0))
3409 {
3410 rtx new_pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
3411 SET_DEST (old_set), new_src);
3412
3413 if (!validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn), new_pat, 0))
3414 SET_SRC (old_set) = new_src;
3415 }
3416 }
3417 else
3418 break;
3419
3420 val = 1;
3421 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3422 to the end. */
3423 goto done;
3424 }
3425 }
3426
3427 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3428 elimination_effects (old_body, VOIDmode);
3429
3430 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3431 can be handled by reload. */
3432 extract_insn (insn);
3433 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3434 {
3435 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3436 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3437
3438 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3439 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3440 {
3441 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3442
3443 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3444 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3445 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3446 {
3447 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3448 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3449 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3450 eliminate this reg. */
3451 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3452 ep++)
3453 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3454 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3455 }
3456
3457 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3458 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3459 is_set_src = false;
3460 if (old_set
3461 && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3462 is_set_src = true;
3463 in_plus = false;
3464 if (plus_src
3465 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3466 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3467 in_plus = true;
3468
3469 substed_operand[i]
3470 = eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], VOIDmode,
3471 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX,
3472 is_set_src || in_plus, false);
3473 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3474 val = 1;
3475 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3476 this point. */
3477 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3478
3479 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3480 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3481 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3482 && REG_P (orig_operand[i])
3483 && MEM_P (substed_operand[i])
3484 && replace)
3485 emit_insn_after (gen_clobber (orig_operand[i]), insn);
3486 }
3487 }
3488
3489 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3490 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3491 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3492
3493 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3494 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3495
3496 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3497 array. */
3498 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3499 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3500 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3501 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3502
3503 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3504 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3505 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3506 common case.
3507 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3508 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3509 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3510 again. */
3511
3512 if (val)
3513 {
3514 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3515 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3516 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3517 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3518 new_body = old_body;
3519 if (! replace)
3520 {
3521 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3522 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3523 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3524 }
3525 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3526
3527 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3528 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3529 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3530 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3531 hurt in this rare case. */
3532 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3533 thing always? */
3534 if (! insn_is_asm
3535 && old_set != 0
3536 && ((REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3537 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3538 || !REG_P (SET_SRC (new_body))))
3539 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3540 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3541 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3542 || (old_set != 0
3543 && ((MEM_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3544 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3545 || (MEM_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3546 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3547 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3548 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3549 {
3550 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3551 if (new_icode >= 0)
3552 INSN_CODE (insn) = new_icode;
3553 }
3554 }
3555
3556 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3557 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3558 a modified insn below. */
3559 if (! replace)
3560 {
3561 /* Restore the old body. */
3562 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3563 /* Restoring a top-level match_parallel would clobber the new_body
3564 we installed in the insn. */
3565 if (recog_data.operand_loc[i] != &PATTERN (insn))
3566 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3567 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3568 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3569 }
3570
3571 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3572 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3573 elimination_effects.
3574
3575 We also detect cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3576 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3577 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3578 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3579 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3580 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3581
3582 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3583
3584 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3585 {
3586 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3587 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3588
3589 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3590
3591 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3592 val = 1;
3593 }
3594
3595 done:
3596 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3597 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3598 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3599 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3600 the pre-passes. */
3601 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3602 REG_NOTES (insn)
3603 = eliminate_regs_1 (REG_NOTES (insn), VOIDmode, REG_NOTES (insn), true,
3604 false);
3605
3606 return val;
3607 }
3608
3609 /* Like eliminate_regs_in_insn, but only estimate costs for the use of the
3610 register allocator. INSN is the instruction we need to examine, we perform
3611 eliminations in its operands and record cases where eliminating a reg with
3612 an invariant equivalence would add extra cost. */
3613
3614 static void
3615 elimination_costs_in_insn (rtx insn)
3616 {
3617 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
3618 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
3619 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
3620 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
3621 int i;
3622 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3623 rtx orig_dup[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3624 struct elim_table *ep;
3625 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
3626 bool sets_reg_p;
3627
3628 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
3629 {
3630 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3631 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
3632 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
3633 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
3634 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT
3635 || DEBUG_INSN_P (insn));
3636 return;
3637 }
3638
3639 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3640 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3641 {
3642 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
3643 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3644 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
3645 return;
3646 }
3647
3648 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3649 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3650 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3651 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3652 sets_reg_p = false;
3653 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3654 {
3655 sets_reg_p = true;
3656 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3657 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3658 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3659 if (plus_src
3660 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3661 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3662 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3663 || plus_src)
3664 {
3665 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3666 (plus (...) CST). */
3667 rtx links;
3668 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3669 {
3670 if ((REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3671 || REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUIV)
3672 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3673 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)))
3674 {
3675 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3676 break;
3677 }
3678 }
3679 }
3680 }
3681
3682 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3683 elimination_effects (old_body, VOIDmode);
3684
3685 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3686 can be handled by reload. */
3687 extract_insn (insn);
3688 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3689 orig_dup[i] = *recog_data.dup_loc[i];
3690
3691 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3692 {
3693 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3694
3695 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3696 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3697 {
3698 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3699
3700 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3701 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3702 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3703 {
3704 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3705 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3706 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3707 eliminate this reg. */
3708 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3709 ep++)
3710 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3711 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3715 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3716 is_set_src = false;
3717 if (old_set && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3718 is_set_src = true;
3719 if (is_set_src && !sets_reg_p)
3720 note_reg_elim_costly (&SET_SRC (old_set), insn);
3721 in_plus = false;
3722 if (plus_src && sets_reg_p
3723 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3724 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3725 in_plus = true;
3726
3727 eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], VOIDmode,
3728 NULL_RTX,
3729 is_set_src || in_plus, true);
3730 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3731 this point. */
3732 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3733 }
3734 }
3735
3736 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3737 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3738 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3739
3740 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3741 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3742
3743 /* Restore the old body. */
3744 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3745 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3746 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3747 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_dup[i];
3748
3749 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3750 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3751 elimination_effects. */
3752
3753 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3754 {
3755 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3756 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3757
3758 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3759 }
3760
3761 return;
3762 }
3763
3764 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3765 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3766
3767 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3768 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3769
3770 static void
3771 update_eliminable_offsets (void)
3772 {
3773 struct elim_table *ep;
3774
3775 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3776 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3777 {
3778 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3779 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3780 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3781 }
3782 }
3783
3784 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3785 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3786 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3787
3788 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3789 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3790 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3791 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3792 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3793 prevent this elimination.
3794
3795 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3796 the insns of the function. */
3797
3798 static void
3799 mark_not_eliminable (rtx dest, const_rtx x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3800 {
3801 unsigned int i;
3802
3803 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3804 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3805 case. */
3806 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3807 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3808
3809 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3810 return;
3811
3812 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3813 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3814 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3815 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3816 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3817 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1))))
3818 {
3819 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3820 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3821 num_eliminable--;
3822 }
3823 }
3824
3825 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3826 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3827 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3828 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3829
3830 static bool
3831 verify_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3832 {
3833 HOST_WIDE_INT t;
3834
3835 if (!num_eliminable)
3836 return true;
3837
3838 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3839 {
3840 struct elim_table *ep;
3841
3842 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3843 {
3844 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3845 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3846 return false;
3847 }
3848 }
3849 #else
3850 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3851 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3852 return false;
3853 #endif
3854
3855 return true;
3856 }
3857
3858 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3859
3860 static void
3861 set_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3862 {
3863 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3864
3865 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3866 for (; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3867 {
3868 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3869 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3870 }
3871 #else
3872 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3873 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3874 #endif
3875
3876 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3877 }
3878
3879 /* Subroutine of set_initial_label_offsets called via for_each_eh_label. */
3880
3881 static void
3882 set_initial_eh_label_offset (rtx label)
3883 {
3884 set_label_offsets (label, NULL_RTX, 1);
3885 }
3886
3887 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3888 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3889 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3890 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3891 at its initial offset.
3892 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3893
3894 static void
3895 set_initial_label_offsets (void)
3896 {
3897 rtx x;
3898 memset (offsets_known_at, 0, num_labels);
3899
3900 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3901 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3902 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3903
3904 for_each_eh_label (set_initial_eh_label_offset);
3905 }
3906
3907 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3908 by INSN. */
3909
3910 static void
3911 set_offsets_for_label (rtx insn)
3912 {
3913 unsigned int i;
3914 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3915 struct elim_table *ep;
3916
3917 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3918 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3919 {
3920 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset
3921 = offsets_at[label_nr - first_label_num][i];
3922 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3923 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3924 }
3925 }
3926
3927 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3928 For example, on the SPARC, whether or not the frame pointer can
3929 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3930 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3931 since they can't have changed. */
3932
3933 static void
3934 update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *pset)
3935 {
3936 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3937 struct elim_table *ep;
3938
3939 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3940 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3941 && targetm.frame_pointer_required ())
3942 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3943 || ! targetm.can_eliminate (ep->from, ep->to)
3944 #endif
3945 )
3946 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3947
3948 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3949 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3950 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3951 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3952 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3953 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3954
3955 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3956 {
3957 struct elim_table *op;
3958 int new_to = -1;
3959
3960 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3961 {
3962 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3963 new one. */
3964 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3965 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3966 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3967 {
3968 new_to = op->to;
3969 break;
3970 }
3971
3972 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3973 disable it. */
3974 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3975 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3976 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3977 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3978 }
3979 }
3980
3981 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3982 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3983 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3984 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3985 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3986
3987 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3988 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3989 {
3990 if (ep->can_eliminate
3991 && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3992 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3993 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
3994 || ! crtl->stack_realign_needed))
3995 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
3996
3997 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3998 {
3999 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
4000 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
4001 num_eliminable--;
4002 }
4003 }
4004
4005 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
4006 the hard frame pointer. */
4007 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
4008 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
4009 }
4010
4011 /* Return true if X is used as the target register of an elimination. */
4012
4013 bool
4014 elimination_target_reg_p (rtx x)
4015 {
4016 struct elim_table *ep;
4017
4018 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
4019 if (ep->to_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
4020 return true;
4021
4022 return false;
4023 }
4024
4025 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate.
4026 Pre-condition: global flag frame_pointer_needed has been set before
4027 calling this function. */
4028
4029 static void
4030 init_elim_table (void)
4031 {
4032 struct elim_table *ep;
4033 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
4034 const struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
4035 #endif
4036
4037 if (!reg_eliminate)
4038 reg_eliminate = XCNEWVEC (struct elim_table, NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
4039
4040 num_eliminable = 0;
4041
4042 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
4043 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
4044 ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
4045 {
4046 ep->from = ep1->from;
4047 ep->to = ep1->to;
4048 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
4049 = (targetm.can_eliminate (ep->from, ep->to)
4050 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
4051 && frame_pointer_needed
4052 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
4053 || ! stack_realign_fp)));
4054 }
4055 #else
4056 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
4057 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
4058 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
4059 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
4060 #endif
4061
4062 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
4063 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx_REG will cause, e.g.,
4064 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
4065 We depend on this. */
4066 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
4067 {
4068 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
4069 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
4070 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
4071 }
4072 }
4073
4074 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
4075 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
4076 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
4077 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
4078
4079 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
4080 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
4081 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
4082 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
4083
4084 static void
4085 init_eliminable_invariants (rtx first, bool do_subregs)
4086 {
4087 int i;
4088 rtx insn;
4089
4090 reg_equiv_constant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4091 reg_equiv_invariant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4092 reg_equiv_mem = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4093 reg_equiv_alt_mem_list = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4094 reg_equiv_address = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4095 if (do_subregs)
4096 reg_max_ref_width = XCNEWVEC (unsigned int, max_regno);
4097 else
4098 reg_max_ref_width = NULL;
4099
4100 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
4101
4102 first_label_num = get_first_label_num ();
4103 num_labels = max_label_num () - first_label_num;
4104
4105 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
4106 offsets_known_at = XNEWVEC (char, num_labels);
4107 offsets_at = (HOST_WIDE_INT (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
4108
4109 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent
4110 to. If DO_SUBREGS is true, also find all paradoxical subregs and
4111 find largest such for each pseudo. FIRST is the head of the insn
4112 list. */
4113
4114 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
4115 {
4116 rtx set = single_set (insn);
4117
4118 /* We may introduce USEs that we want to remove at the end, so
4119 we'll mark them with QImode. Make sure there are no
4120 previously-marked insns left by say regmove. */
4121 if (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
4122 && GET_MODE (insn) != VOIDmode)
4123 PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
4124
4125 if (do_subregs && NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
4126 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
4127
4128 if (set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set)))
4129 {
4130 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
4131 rtx x;
4132
4133 if (! note)
4134 continue;
4135
4136 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
4137 x = XEXP (note, 0);
4138
4139 if (i <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
4140 continue;
4141
4142 /* If flag_pic and we have constant, verify it's legitimate. */
4143 if (!CONSTANT_P (x)
4144 || !flag_pic || LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x))
4145 {
4146 /* It can happen that a REG_EQUIV note contains a MEM
4147 that is not a legitimate memory operand. As later
4148 stages of reload assume that all addresses found
4149 in the reg_equiv_* arrays were originally legitimate,
4150 we ignore such REG_EQUIV notes. */
4151 if (memory_operand (x, VOIDmode))
4152 {
4153 /* Always unshare the equivalence, so we can
4154 substitute into this insn without touching the
4155 equivalence. */
4156 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = copy_rtx (x);
4157 }
4158 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
4159 {
4160 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
4161 {
4162 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
4163 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
4164 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = copy_rtx (x);
4165 num_eliminable_invariants++;
4166 }
4167 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
4168 {
4169 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = x;
4170 num_eliminable_invariants++;
4171 }
4172 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
4173 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
4174 else
4175 {
4176 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
4177 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
4178 if (! reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
4179 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
4180 }
4181 }
4182 else
4183 {
4184 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
4185 continue;
4186 }
4187 }
4188 else
4189 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
4190 }
4191 }
4192
4193 if (dump_file)
4194 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
4195 if (reg_equiv_init[i])
4196 {
4197 fprintf (dump_file, "init_insns for %u: ", i);
4198 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, reg_equiv_init[i], 20);
4199 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4200 }
4201 }
4202
4203 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants.
4204 Free all data involved in tracking these. */
4205
4206 static void
4207 free_reg_equiv (void)
4208 {
4209 int i;
4210
4211 if (reg_equiv_constant)
4212 free (reg_equiv_constant);
4213 if (reg_equiv_invariant)
4214 free (reg_equiv_invariant);
4215 reg_equiv_constant = 0;
4216 reg_equiv_invariant = 0;
4217 VEC_free (rtx, gc, reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec);
4218 reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;
4219
4220 if (offsets_known_at)
4221 free (offsets_known_at);
4222 if (offsets_at)
4223 free (offsets_at);
4224 offsets_at = 0;
4225 offsets_known_at = 0;
4226
4227 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4228 if (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[i])
4229 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[i]);
4230 free (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list);
4231
4232 free (reg_equiv_mem);
4233 free (reg_equiv_address);
4234 }
4235 \f
4236 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
4237
4238 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
4239 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
4240 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
4241 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
4242 hard reg to produce another spill register.
4243
4244 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
4245
4246 static void
4247 spill_hard_reg (unsigned int regno, int cant_eliminate)
4248 {
4249 int i;
4250
4251 if (cant_eliminate)
4252 {
4253 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
4254 df_set_regs_ever_live (regno, true);
4255 }
4256
4257 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
4258 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
4259
4260 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
4261 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
4262 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
4263 && end_hard_regno (PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i), reg_renumber[i]) > regno)
4264 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
4265 }
4266
4267 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
4268 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
4269 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
4270 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
4271
4272 static int
4273 finish_spills (int global)
4274 {
4275 struct insn_chain *chain;
4276 int something_changed = 0;
4277 unsigned i;
4278 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4279
4280 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
4281 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
4282 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
4283 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
4284 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
4285
4286 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
4287 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
4288 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
4289 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
4290 but must be saved by the prologue. */
4291
4292 n_spills = 0;
4293 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4294 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
4295 {
4296 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
4297 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
4298 if (num_eliminable && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (i))
4299 something_changed = 1;
4300 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
4301 }
4302 else
4303 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
4304
4305 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4306 if (! ira_conflicts_p || reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
4307 {
4308 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to
4309 in pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the
4310 same hard reg in a later pass. */
4311 gcc_assert (reg_renumber[i] >= 0);
4312
4313 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
4314 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
4315 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
4316 if (ira_conflicts_p)
4317 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
4318 ira_mark_allocation_change (i);
4319 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
4320 something_changed = 1;
4321 }
4322
4323 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
4324 if (global && ira_conflicts_p)
4325 {
4326 unsigned int n;
4327
4328 memset (pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
4329 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
4330 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
4331 insn. */
4332 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
4333 {
4334 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
4335 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4336 {
4337 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
4338 chain->used_spill_regs);
4339 }
4340 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
4341 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4342 {
4343 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
4344 chain->used_spill_regs);
4345 }
4346 }
4347
4348 /* Retry allocating the pseudos spilled in IRA and the
4349 reload. For each reg, merge the various reg sets that
4350 indicate which hard regs can't be used, and call
4351 ira_reassign_pseudos. */
4352 for (n = 0, i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned) max_regno; i++)
4353 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
4354 {
4355 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
4356 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
4357 else
4358 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
4359 }
4360 if (ira_reassign_pseudos (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n,
4361 bad_spill_regs_global,
4362 pseudo_forbidden_regs, pseudo_previous_regs,
4363 &spilled_pseudos))
4364 something_changed = 1;
4365 }
4366 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
4367 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
4368 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
4369 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
4370 {
4371 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
4372 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
4373
4374 if (! ira_conflicts_p)
4375 {
4376 /* Don't do it for IRA because IRA and the reload still can
4377 assign hard registers to the spilled pseudos on next
4378 reload iterations. */
4379 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
4380 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
4381 }
4382 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
4383 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
4384 if (chain->need_reload)
4385 {
4386 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4387 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
4388 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
4389
4390 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4391 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
4392 /* Value of chain->used_spill_regs from previous iteration
4393 may be not included in the value calculated here because
4394 of possible removing caller-saves insns (see function
4395 delete_caller_save_insns. */
4396 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
4397 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
4398 }
4399 }
4400
4401 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
4402 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
4403 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
4404 {
4405 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
4406 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
4407 continue;
4408
4409 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos, i);
4410
4411 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i], false);
4412 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
4413 if (dump_file)
4414 {
4415 if (regno == -1)
4416 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
4417 else
4418 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
4419 i, reg_renumber[i]);
4420 }
4421 }
4422
4423 return something_changed;
4424 }
4425 \f
4426 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width. */
4427
4428 static void
4429 scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx x)
4430 {
4431 int i;
4432 const char *fmt;
4433 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
4434
4435 switch (code)
4436 {
4437 case REG:
4438 case CONST_INT:
4439 case CONST:
4440 case SYMBOL_REF:
4441 case LABEL_REF:
4442 case CONST_DOUBLE:
4443 case CONST_FIXED:
4444 case CONST_VECTOR: /* shouldn't happen, but just in case. */
4445 case CC0:
4446 case PC:
4447 case USE:
4448 case CLOBBER:
4449 return;
4450
4451 case SUBREG:
4452 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4453 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
4454 > reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]))
4455 {
4456 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
4457 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
4458 mark_home_live_1 (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)), GET_MODE (x));
4459 }
4460 return;
4461
4462 default:
4463 break;
4464 }
4465
4466 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
4467 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4468 {
4469 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
4470 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
4471 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
4472 {
4473 int j;
4474 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
4475 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
4476 }
4477 }
4478 }
4479 \f
4480 /* A subroutine of reload_as_needed. If INSN has a REG_EH_REGION note,
4481 examine all of the reload insns between PREV and NEXT exclusive, and
4482 annotate all that may trap. */
4483
4484 static void
4485 fixup_eh_region_note (rtx insn, rtx prev, rtx next)
4486 {
4487 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
4488 if (note == NULL)
4489 return;
4490 if (!insn_could_throw_p (insn))
4491 remove_note (insn, note);
4492 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (note, NEXT_INSN (prev), next);
4493 }
4494
4495 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
4496 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
4497 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
4498
4499 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
4500 which registers are already available in reload registers.
4501 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
4502 as the insns are scanned. */
4503
4504 static void
4505 reload_as_needed (int live_known)
4506 {
4507 struct insn_chain *chain;
4508 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
4509 int i;
4510 #endif
4511 rtx x;
4512
4513 memset (spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
4514 memset (spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
4515 reg_last_reload_reg = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4516 INIT_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4517 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4518 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4519
4520 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
4521
4522 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
4523 {
4524 rtx prev = 0;
4525 rtx insn = chain->insn;
4526 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4527 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4528 rtx old_prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4529 #endif
4530
4531 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
4532 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
4533 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4534 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
4535
4536 else if (INSN_P (insn))
4537 {
4538 regset_head regs_to_forget;
4539 INIT_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4540 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), forget_old_reloads_1, &regs_to_forget);
4541
4542 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
4543 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
4544
4545 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
4546 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
4547 && MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))
4548 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
4549 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
4550 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
4551 NULL_RTX);
4552
4553 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
4554 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
4555 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
4556 {
4557 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
4558 if (NOTE_P (insn))
4559 {
4560 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4561 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4562 continue;
4563 }
4564 }
4565
4566 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
4567 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
4568 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
4569 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
4570 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
4571 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
4572
4573 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
4574 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
4575 n_reloads = 0;
4576 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
4577 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
4578 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
4579 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
4580 else
4581 {
4582 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4583 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
4584
4585 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
4586 spill_reg_order);
4587 }
4588
4589 if (n_reloads > 0)
4590 {
4591 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4592 rtx p;
4593
4594 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4595
4596 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
4597 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
4598 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
4599 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
4600 choose_reload_regs (chain);
4601
4602 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
4603 their reload regs. */
4604 emit_reload_insns (chain);
4605
4606 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
4607 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
4608 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
4609 and that we moved the structure into). */
4610 subst_reloads (insn);
4611
4612 /* Adjust the exception region notes for loads and stores. */
4613 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions && !CALL_P (insn))
4614 fixup_eh_region_note (insn, prev, next);
4615
4616 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
4617 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
4618 and delete them. */
4619 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
4620 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
4621 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
4622 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) != USE
4623 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
4624 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
4625 {
4626 error_for_asm (insn,
4627 "%<asm%> operand requires "
4628 "impossible reload");
4629 delete_insn (p);
4630 }
4631 }
4632
4633 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
4634 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4635
4636 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
4637 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
4638 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
4639 for this insn in order to be stored in
4640 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
4641 registers ARE still valid. */
4642 forget_marked_reloads (&regs_to_forget);
4643 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4644
4645 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
4646 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
4647 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4648 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (x) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
4649 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
4650
4651 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4652 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
4653 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
4654 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
4655 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
4656 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4657 {
4658 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
4659 if (in_reg)
4660 {
4661 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
4662 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
4663 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
4664 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
4665 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
4666 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
4667 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4668 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4669 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4670 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4671 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4672 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4673 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4674
4675 {
4676 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4677 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
4678 int n = 0;
4679 rtx p;
4680
4681 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
4682 {
4683 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
4684 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
4685 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
4686 break;
4687 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
4688 if (! n)
4689 continue;
4690 if (n == 1)
4691 {
4692 rtx replace_reg
4693 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, mode, reload_reg);
4694
4695 validate_replace_rtx_group (reload_reg,
4696 replace_reg, p);
4697 n = verify_changes (0);
4698
4699 /* We must also verify that the constraints
4700 are met after the replacement. Make sure
4701 extract_insn is only called for an insn
4702 where the replacements were found to be
4703 valid so far. */
4704 if (n)
4705 {
4706 extract_insn (p);
4707 n = constrain_operands (1);
4708 }
4709
4710 /* If the constraints were not met, then
4711 undo the replacement, else confirm it. */
4712 if (!n)
4713 cancel_changes (0);
4714 else
4715 confirm_change_group ();
4716 }
4717 break;
4718 }
4719 if (n == 1)
4720 {
4721 add_reg_note (p, REG_INC, reload_reg);
4722 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4723 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4724 the reload for inheritance. */
4725 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4726 REGNO (reload_reg));
4727 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4728 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4729 }
4730 else
4731 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
4732 NULL);
4733 }
4734 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
4735 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4736 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4737 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4738 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4739 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4740 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4741 {
4742 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4743 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
4744 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4745 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4746 }
4747 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC
4748 || code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4749 {
4750 int in_regno = REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0));
4751
4752 if (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] != NULL_RTX)
4753 {
4754 int in_hard_regno;
4755 bool forget_p = true;
4756
4757 in_hard_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno]);
4758 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4759 in_hard_regno))
4760 {
4761 for (x = old_prev ? NEXT_INSN (old_prev) : insn;
4762 x != old_next;
4763 x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4764 if (x == reg_reloaded_insn[in_hard_regno])
4765 {
4766 forget_p = false;
4767 break;
4768 }
4769 }
4770 /* If for some reasons, we didn't set up
4771 reg_last_reload_reg in this insn,
4772 invalidate inheritance from previous
4773 insns for the incremented/decremented
4774 register. Such registers will be not in
4775 reg_has_output_reload. Invalidate it
4776 also if the corresponding element in
4777 reg_reloaded_insn is also
4778 invalidated. */
4779 if (forget_p)
4780 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0),
4781 NULL_RTX, NULL);
4782 }
4783 }
4784 }
4785 }
4786 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4787 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4788 hard registers. */
4789 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
4790 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
4791 {
4792 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4793 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4794 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4795 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4796 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
4797 break;
4798
4799 if (i == n_reloads)
4800 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
4801 }
4802 #endif
4803 }
4804 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4805 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4806 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4807
4808 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4809 if it is a call-used reg, or if it contains a value that will
4810 be partially clobbered by the call. */
4811 else if (CALL_P (insn))
4812 {
4813 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
4814 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4815 }
4816 }
4817
4818 /* Clean up. */
4819 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
4820 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4821 }
4822
4823 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4824 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4825 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4826
4827 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4828 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from.
4829
4830 When DATA is non-NULL just mark the registers in regset
4831 to be forgotten later. */
4832
4833 static void
4834 forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx x, const_rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4835 void *data)
4836 {
4837 unsigned int regno;
4838 unsigned int nr;
4839 regset regs = (regset) data;
4840
4841 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4842 subreg_regno_offset requires a hard reg. */
4843 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4844 {
4845 /* We ignore the subreg offset when calculating the regno,
4846 because we are using the entire underlying hard register
4847 below. */
4848 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4849 }
4850
4851 if (!REG_P (x))
4852 return;
4853
4854 regno = REGNO (x);
4855
4856 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4857 nr = 1;
4858 else
4859 {
4860 unsigned int i;
4861
4862 nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)];
4863 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4864 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4865 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4866 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4867 if (!regs)
4868 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4869 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4870 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4871 if (n_reloads == 0
4872 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4873 {
4874 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4875 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4876 }
4877 }
4878
4879 if (regs)
4880 while (nr-- > 0)
4881 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (regs, regno + nr);
4882 else
4883 {
4884 /* Since value of X has changed,
4885 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4886
4887 while (nr-- > 0)
4888 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4889 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4890 if (n_reloads == 0
4891 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, regno + nr))
4892 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4893 }
4894 }
4895
4896 /* Forget the reloads marked in regset by previous function. */
4897 static void
4898 forget_marked_reloads (regset regs)
4899 {
4900 unsigned int reg;
4901 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4902 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (regs, 0, reg, rsi)
4903 {
4904 if (reg < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4905 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4906 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4907 && (n_reloads == 0
4908 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, reg)))
4909 {
4910 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reg);
4911 spill_reg_store[reg] = 0;
4912 }
4913 if (n_reloads == 0
4914 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, reg))
4915 reg_last_reload_reg[reg] = 0;
4916 }
4917 }
4918 \f
4919 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4920 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4921
4922 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4923 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
4924 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4925 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
4926 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4927 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4928 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4929 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4930 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4931 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4932 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4933 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4934 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4935 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4936 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4937 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4938 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4939 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4940 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4941 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4942 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4943 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4944 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4945 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4946
4947 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4948 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
4949
4950 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4951 in the group. */
4952 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
4953
4954 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4955 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4956 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
4957
4958 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4959 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4960 actually used. */
4961
4962 static void
4963 mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type,
4964 enum machine_mode mode)
4965 {
4966 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
4967 unsigned int i;
4968
4969 for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
4970 {
4971 switch (type)
4972 {
4973 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4974 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
4975 break;
4976
4977 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4978 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
4979 break;
4980
4981 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4982 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4983 break;
4984
4985 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4986 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
4987 break;
4988
4989 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4990 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4991 break;
4992
4993 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4994 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
4995 break;
4996
4997 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4998 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
4999 break;
5000
5001 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5002 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
5003 break;
5004
5005 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5006 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
5007 break;
5008
5009 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5010 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
5011 break;
5012
5013 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5014 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
5015 break;
5016 }
5017
5018 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
5019 }
5020 }
5021
5022 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
5023
5024 static void
5025 clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum,
5026 enum reload_type type, enum machine_mode mode)
5027 {
5028 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
5029 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
5030 int i;
5031 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
5032 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
5033 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
5034 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
5035 int check_opnum = 0;
5036 int check_any = 0;
5037 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
5038
5039 switch (type)
5040 {
5041 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5042 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
5043 break;
5044
5045 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5046 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
5047 break;
5048
5049 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5050 check_opnum = 1;
5051 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
5052 break;
5053
5054 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5055 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
5056 break;
5057
5058 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5059 check_opnum = 1;
5060 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
5061 break;
5062
5063 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5064 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
5065 break;
5066
5067 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5068 check_any = 1;
5069 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
5070 break;
5071
5072 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5073 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
5074 check_any = 1;
5075 break;
5076
5077 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5078 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
5079 break;
5080
5081 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5082 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
5083 break;
5084
5085 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5086 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
5087 break;
5088 default:
5089 gcc_unreachable ();
5090 }
5091 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
5092 excluding the intervals of reload registers by them from the
5093 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
5094 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
5095 more than what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
5096 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
5097 be no reason to worry about it. */
5098
5099 start_regno = regno;
5100 end_regno = regno + nregs;
5101 if (check_opnum || check_any)
5102 {
5103 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5104 {
5105 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
5106 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
5107 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
5108 {
5109 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
5110 unsigned int conflict_end
5111 = end_hard_regno (rld[i].mode, conflict_start);
5112
5113 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
5114 adjust the interval start. */
5115 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
5116 start_regno = conflict_end;
5117 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
5118 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
5119 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
5120 end_regno = conflict_start;
5121 }
5122 }
5123 }
5124
5125 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
5126 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
5127 }
5128
5129 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
5130 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
5131
5132 static int
5133 reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
5134 {
5135 int i;
5136
5137 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
5138 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
5139 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
5140 return 0;
5141
5142 switch (type)
5143 {
5144 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5145 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
5146 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
5147 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5148 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
5149 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
5150 return 0;
5151
5152 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5153 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5154 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5155 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5156 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5157 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
5158 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5159 return 0;
5160
5161 return 1;
5162
5163 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5164 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5165 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
5166 return 0;
5167
5168 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
5169 return 0;
5170
5171 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
5172 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5173 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5174 return 0;
5175
5176 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
5177 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5178 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5179 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
5180 return 0;
5181
5182 return 1;
5183
5184 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5185 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
5186 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
5187 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
5188 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5189 return 0;
5190
5191 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5192 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5193 return 0;
5194
5195 return 1;
5196
5197 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5198 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
5199 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
5200 one. */
5201 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5202 return 0;
5203
5204 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5205 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5206 return 0;
5207
5208 return 1;
5209
5210 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5211 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
5212 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. Note
5213 that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order, so
5214 the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
5215 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
5216 return 0;
5217
5218 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
5219 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5220 return 0;
5221
5222 return 1;
5223
5224 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5225 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
5226 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
5227 later operand. Note that multiple output operands are
5228 emitted in reverse order, so the conflicting ones are
5229 those with lower indices. */
5230 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5231 return 0;
5232
5233 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
5234 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5235 return 0;
5236
5237 return 1;
5238
5239 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5240 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5241 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5242 return 0;
5243
5244 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5245 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
5246
5247 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5248 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5249 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5250 return 0;
5251
5252 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
5253
5254 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5255 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
5256 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.
5257 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
5258 so the conflicting ones are those with higher indices. */
5259 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
5260 return 0;
5261
5262 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5263 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5264 return 0;
5265
5266 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5267 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5268 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
5269 return 0;
5270
5271 return 1;
5272
5273 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5274 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5275 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
5276 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5277 return 0;
5278
5279 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5280 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
5281
5282 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5283 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
5284
5285 default:
5286 gcc_unreachable ();
5287 }
5288 }
5289
5290 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
5291 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
5292 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
5293
5294 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
5295 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
5296 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
5297
5298 static int
5299 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
5300 {
5301 int i;
5302
5303 switch (type)
5304 {
5305 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5306 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
5307 its value must reach the end. */
5308 return 1;
5309
5310 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
5311 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
5312 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
5313 of fallthroughs. */
5314
5315 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5316 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
5317 with anything else and everything comes later. */
5318
5319 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5320 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5321 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5322 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
5323 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5324 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5325 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5326 return 0;
5327
5328 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5329 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
5330 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5331 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5332
5333 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5334 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5335 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
5336 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
5337 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
5338 conflict. */
5339
5340 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5341 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5342 return 0;
5343
5344 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5345 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5346 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
5347 return 0;
5348
5349 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5350 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5351 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5352 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5353 return 0;
5354
5355 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
5356 return 0;
5357
5358 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5359 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5360 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5361
5362 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5363 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
5364 both input and input address and we do not check for
5365 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
5366 would conflict. */
5367
5368 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5369 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5370 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5371 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5372 return 0;
5373
5374 /* ... fall through ... */
5375
5376 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5377 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
5378
5379 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5380 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5381 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5382 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5383 return 0;
5384
5385 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5386
5387 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5388 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5389 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5390 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5391 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5392 return 0;
5393
5394 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5395 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5396 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5397
5398 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5399 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
5400 we need only check for output addresses. */
5401
5402 opnum = reload_n_operands;
5403
5404 /* ... fall through ... */
5405
5406 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5407 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5408 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5409 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
5410 only thing to check are later output addresses.
5411 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
5412 so the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
5413 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5414 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5415 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
5416 return 0;
5417
5418 return 1;
5419
5420 default:
5421 gcc_unreachable ();
5422 }
5423 }
5424
5425 /* Like reload_reg_reaches_end_p, but check that the condition holds for
5426 every register in the range [REGNO, REGNO + NREGS). */
5427
5428 static bool
5429 reload_regs_reach_end_p (unsigned int regno, int nregs,
5430 int opnum, enum reload_type type)
5431 {
5432 int i;
5433
5434 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
5435 if (!reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno + i, opnum, type))
5436 return false;
5437 return true;
5438 }
5439 \f
5440
5441 /* Returns whether R1 and R2 are uniquely chained: the value of one
5442 is used by the other, and that value is not used by any other
5443 reload for this insn. This is used to partially undo the decision
5444 made in find_reloads when in the case of multiple
5445 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads it converts all
5446 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reloads into RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5447 reloads. This code tries to avoid the conflict created by that
5448 change. It might be cleaner to explicitly keep track of which
5449 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload is associated with which
5450 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload, rather than to try to detect
5451 this after the fact. */
5452 static bool
5453 reloads_unique_chain_p (int r1, int r2)
5454 {
5455 int i;
5456
5457 /* We only check input reloads. */
5458 if (! rld[r1].in || ! rld[r2].in)
5459 return false;
5460
5461 /* Avoid anything with output reloads. */
5462 if (rld[r1].out || rld[r2].out)
5463 return false;
5464
5465 /* "chained" means one reload is a component of the other reload,
5466 not the same as the other reload. */
5467 if (rld[r1].opnum != rld[r2].opnum
5468 || rtx_equal_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5469 || rld[r1].optional || rld[r2].optional
5470 || ! (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5471 || reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in)))
5472 return false;
5473
5474 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i ++)
5475 /* Look for input reloads that aren't our two */
5476 if (i != r1 && i != r2 && rld[i].in)
5477 {
5478 /* If our reload is mentioned at all, it isn't a simple chain. */
5479 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[i].in))
5480 return false;
5481 }
5482 return true;
5483 }
5484
5485 /* The recursive function change all occurrences of WHAT in *WHERE
5486 to REPL. */
5487 static void
5488 substitute (rtx *where, const_rtx what, rtx repl)
5489 {
5490 const char *fmt;
5491 int i;
5492 enum rtx_code code;
5493
5494 if (*where == 0)
5495 return;
5496
5497 if (*where == what || rtx_equal_p (*where, what))
5498 {
5499 /* Record the location of the changed rtx. */
5500 VEC_safe_push (rtx_p, heap, substitute_stack, where);
5501 *where = repl;
5502 return;
5503 }
5504
5505 code = GET_CODE (*where);
5506 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
5507 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5508 {
5509 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
5510 {
5511 int j;
5512
5513 for (j = XVECLEN (*where, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
5514 substitute (&XVECEXP (*where, i, j), what, repl);
5515 }
5516 else if (fmt[i] == 'e')
5517 substitute (&XEXP (*where, i), what, repl);
5518 }
5519 }
5520
5521 /* The function returns TRUE if chain of reload R1 and R2 (in any
5522 order) can be evaluated without usage of intermediate register for
5523 the reload containing another reload. It is important to see
5524 gen_reload to understand what the function is trying to do. As an
5525 example, let us have reload chain
5526
5527 r2: const
5528 r1: <something> + const
5529
5530 and reload R2 got reload reg HR. The function returns true if
5531 there is a correct insn HR = HR + <something>. Otherwise,
5532 gen_reload will use intermediate register (and this is the reload
5533 reg for R1) to reload <something>.
5534
5535 We need this function to find a conflict for chain reloads. In our
5536 example, if HR = HR + <something> is incorrect insn, then we cannot
5537 use HR as a reload register for R2. If we do use it then we get a
5538 wrong code:
5539
5540 HR = const
5541 HR = <something>
5542 HR = HR + HR
5543
5544 */
5545 static bool
5546 gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int r1, int r2)
5547 {
5548 /* Assume other cases in gen_reload are not possible for
5549 chain reloads or do need an intermediate hard registers. */
5550 bool result = true;
5551 int regno, n, code;
5552 rtx out, in, tem, insn;
5553 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
5554
5555 /* Make r2 a component of r1. */
5556 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in))
5557 {
5558 n = r1;
5559 r1 = r2;
5560 r2 = n;
5561 }
5562 gcc_assert (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in));
5563 regno = rld[r1].regno >= 0 ? rld[r1].regno : rld[r2].regno;
5564 gcc_assert (regno >= 0);
5565 out = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r1].mode, regno);
5566 in = rld[r1].in;
5567 substitute (&in, rld[r2].in, gen_rtx_REG (rld[r2].mode, regno));
5568
5569 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
5570 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
5571 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
5572 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
5573 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
5574 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
5575 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
5576
5577 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
5578 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
5579 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
5580 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
5581 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5582 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
5583 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5584 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
5585 {
5586 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
5587 code = recog_memoized (insn);
5588 result = false;
5589
5590 if (code >= 0)
5591 {
5592 extract_insn (insn);
5593 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
5594 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after
5595 reload has completed. */
5596 result = constrain_operands (1);
5597 }
5598
5599 delete_insns_since (last);
5600 }
5601
5602 /* Restore the original value at each changed address within R1. */
5603 while (!VEC_empty (rtx_p, substitute_stack))
5604 {
5605 rtx *where = VEC_pop (rtx_p, substitute_stack);
5606 *where = rld[r2].in;
5607 }
5608
5609 return result;
5610 }
5611
5612 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
5613 Return 0 otherwise.
5614
5615 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
5616
5617 static int
5618 reloads_conflict (int r1, int r2)
5619 {
5620 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
5621 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
5622 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
5623 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
5624
5625 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
5626 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
5627 return 1;
5628
5629 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
5630
5631 switch (r1_type)
5632 {
5633 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5634 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5635 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5636 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
5637 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5638 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5639 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
5640 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
5641
5642 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5643 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5644 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5645
5646 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5647 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5648 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5649
5650 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5651 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5652 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5653
5654 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5655 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5656 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5657
5658 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5659 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5660 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5661 && (!reloads_unique_chain_p (r1, r2)
5662 || !gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (r1, r2))));
5663
5664 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5665 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5666 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
5667
5668 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5669 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5670 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
5671 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
5672 && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
5673
5674 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5675 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5676 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5677 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
5678
5679 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5680 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
5681
5682 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5683 return 1;
5684
5685 default:
5686 gcc_unreachable ();
5687 }
5688 }
5689 \f
5690 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
5691 inherited from previous insns. */
5692 static char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
5693
5694 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
5695 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
5696 static rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
5697
5698 /* If nonzero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
5699 rather than using reload_in. */
5700 static rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
5701
5702 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
5703 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
5704 static int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
5705
5706 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the input mode. */
5707 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_input[MAX_RELOADS];
5708
5709 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the output mode. */
5710 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_output[MAX_RELOADS];
5711
5712 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
5713 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
5714 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
5715
5716 static int
5717 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int start_regno, int regno, int opnum,
5718 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out,
5719 int reloadnum, int ignore_address_reloads)
5720 {
5721 int time1;
5722 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
5723 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
5724 register with an output or input-output reload. */
5725 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
5726 int i;
5727 int copy = 0;
5728
5729 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
5730 return 0;
5731
5732 if (out == const0_rtx)
5733 {
5734 copy = 1;
5735 out = NULL_RTX;
5736 }
5737
5738 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
5739 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
5740 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
5741 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
5742 monotonic.
5743 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
5744 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
5745 such reload type.
5746 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
5747 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
5748 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
5749 becomes live.
5750 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
5751 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
5752 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
5753 switch (type)
5754 {
5755 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5756 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
5757 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
5758 break;
5759 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5760 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5761 break;
5762 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
5763 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
5764 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
5765 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
5766 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
5767 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
5768 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5769 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
5770 break;
5771 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5772 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
5773 break;
5774 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5775 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
5776 executes (inclusive). */
5777 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5778 break;
5779 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5780 /* opnum * 4 + 4
5781 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
5782 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5783 break;
5784 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5785 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
5786 is executed. */
5787 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5788 break;
5789 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5790 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
5791 break;
5792 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5793 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
5794 break;
5795 default:
5796 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5797 }
5798
5799 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5800 {
5801 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
5802 if (reg && REG_P (reg)
5803 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
5804 <= hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (reg)][GET_MODE (reg)] - (unsigned) 1)
5805 && i != reloadnum)
5806 {
5807 rtx other_input = rld[i].in;
5808
5809 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
5810 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
5811 the same register. */
5812 if (true_regnum (reg) != start_regno)
5813 other_input = NULL_RTX;
5814 if (! other_input || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)
5815 || rld[i].out || out)
5816 {
5817 int time2;
5818 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
5819 {
5820 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5821 time2 = 0;
5822 break;
5823 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5824 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
5825 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
5826 by at most one - the first -
5827 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
5828 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
5829 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
5830 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5831 && ignore_address_reloads
5832 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
5833 Then the address address is still needed to store
5834 back the new address. */
5835 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5836 continue;
5837 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
5838 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5839 reloads go away. */
5840 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5841 && ignore_address_reloads
5842 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
5843 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5844 continue;
5845 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
5846 break;
5847 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5848 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5849 && ignore_address_reloads
5850 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5851 continue;
5852 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
5853 break;
5854 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5855 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
5856 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5857 break;
5858 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
5859 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
5860 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5861 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5862 && ignore_address_reloads
5863 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5864 continue;
5865 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5866 break;
5867 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5868 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
5869 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5870 break;
5871 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5872 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5873 break;
5874 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5875 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
5876 instruction is executed. */
5877 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5878 break;
5879 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
5880 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
5881 value. */
5882 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5883 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5884 && ignore_address_reloads
5885 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5886 continue;
5887 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
5888 break;
5889 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5890 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
5891 break;
5892 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5893 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
5894 like an output reload. */
5895 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (other_input, value))
5896 {
5897 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5898 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5899 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
5900 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5901
5902 break;
5903 }
5904 time2 = 1;
5905 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
5906 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
5907 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
5908 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
5909 if (out)
5910 return 0;
5911 break;
5912 default:
5913 return 0;
5914 }
5915 if ((time1 >= time2
5916 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
5917 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)))
5918 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
5919 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
5920 return 0;
5921 }
5922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5926 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
5927 return 0;
5928
5929 return 1;
5930 }
5931
5932 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
5933 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
5934 may be used to load VALUE into it.
5935
5936 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
5937 determine how many hard regs to test.
5938
5939 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
5940 unless OUT is nonzero and these other reloads have to live while
5941 output reloads live.
5942 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
5943 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
5944 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
5945
5946 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
5947 a reload does not conflict with itself.
5948
5949 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
5950 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
5951
5952 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
5953 register. */
5954
5955 static int
5956 free_for_value_p (int regno, enum machine_mode mode, int opnum,
5957 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out, int reloadnum,
5958 int ignore_address_reloads)
5959 {
5960 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
5961 while (nregs-- > 0)
5962 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, regno + nregs, opnum, type,
5963 value, out, reloadnum,
5964 ignore_address_reloads))
5965 return 0;
5966 return 1;
5967 }
5968
5969 /* Return nonzero if the rtx X is invariant over the current function. */
5970 /* ??? Actually, the places where we use this expect exactly what is
5971 tested here, and not everything that is function invariant. In
5972 particular, the frame pointer and arg pointer are special cased;
5973 pic_offset_table_rtx is not, and we must not spill these things to
5974 memory. */
5975
5976 int
5977 function_invariant_p (const_rtx x)
5978 {
5979 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
5980 return 1;
5981 if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
5982 return 1;
5983 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
5984 && (XEXP (x, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx || XEXP (x, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx)
5985 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5986 return 1;
5987 return 0;
5988 }
5989
5990 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
5991 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
5992
5993 static int
5994 conflicts_with_override (rtx x)
5995 {
5996 int i;
5997 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5998 if (reload_override_in[i]
5999 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, reload_override_in[i]))
6000 return 1;
6001 return 0;
6002 }
6003 \f
6004 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
6005 and clear out reload R. */
6006 static void
6007 failed_reload (rtx insn, int r)
6008 {
6009 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
6010 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6011 fatal_insn ("could not find a spill register", insn);
6012
6013 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
6014 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
6015 error_for_asm (insn,
6016 "%<asm%> operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
6017 rld[r].in = 0;
6018 rld[r].out = 0;
6019 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
6020 rld[r].optional = 1;
6021 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
6022 }
6023
6024 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
6025 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
6026 successful. */
6027 static int
6028 set_reload_reg (int i, int r)
6029 {
6030 int regno;
6031 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
6032
6033 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
6034 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
6035 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
6036
6037 regno = true_regnum (reg);
6038
6039 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
6040 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
6041 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
6042 {
6043 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
6044 if (rld[r].in)
6045 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
6046 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
6047 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
6048 We have already tested that for validity. */
6049 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
6050 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
6051 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
6052 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
6053 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
6054 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
6055 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
6056 {
6057 /* The reg is OK. */
6058 last_spill_reg = i;
6059
6060 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
6061 for this. */
6062 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
6063 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
6064
6065 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
6066 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
6067 return 1;
6068 }
6069 }
6070 return 0;
6071 }
6072
6073 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
6074 LAST_RELOAD is nonzero if this is the last reload for the insn being
6075 processed.
6076
6077 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
6078
6079 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
6080 we didn't change anything. */
6081
6082 static int
6083 allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int r,
6084 int last_reload)
6085 {
6086 int i, pass, count;
6087
6088 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
6089 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
6090 reg that some other reload needs.
6091 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
6092 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
6093 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
6094 for this insn.
6095
6096 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
6097 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
6098 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
6099 by use of more alternatives. */
6100
6101 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
6102
6103 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
6104 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
6105 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
6106
6107 We use three passes so we can first look for reload regs to
6108 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
6109 and only then use additional registers which are not "bad", then
6110 finally any register.
6111
6112 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
6113 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
6114 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
6115 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
6116 That leaves none for C. */
6117 for (pass = 0; pass < 3; pass++)
6118 {
6119 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
6120 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
6121 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
6122 of leapfrogging each other. */
6123
6124 i = last_spill_reg;
6125
6126 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
6127 {
6128 int rclass = (int) rld[r].rclass;
6129 int regnum;
6130
6131 i++;
6132 if (i >= n_spills)
6133 i -= n_spills;
6134 regnum = spill_regs[i];
6135
6136 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
6137 rld[r].when_needed)
6138 || (rld[r].in
6139 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
6140 don't clobber the return register. */
6141 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
6142 && free_for_value_p (regnum, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
6143 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6144 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
6145 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regnum)
6146 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
6147 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
6148 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
6149 the ones we want to preserve. */
6150 && (pass
6151 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
6152 regnum)
6153 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6154 regnum))))
6155 {
6156 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regnum][rld[r].mode];
6157
6158 /* During the second pass we want to avoid reload registers
6159 which are "bad" for this reload. */
6160 if (pass == 1
6161 && ira_bad_reload_regno (regnum, rld[r].in, rld[r].out))
6162 continue;
6163
6164 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
6165 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
6166 we would reject both of them. */
6167 if (force_group)
6168 nr = rld[r].nregs;
6169 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
6170 if (nr == 1)
6171 {
6172 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
6173 if (force_group)
6174 continue;
6175 break;
6176 }
6177 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
6178 are available here. */
6179 while (nr > 1)
6180 {
6181 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
6182 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regno)
6183 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
6184 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
6185 rld[r].when_needed)))
6186 break;
6187 nr--;
6188 }
6189 if (nr == 1)
6190 break;
6191 }
6192 }
6193
6194 /* If we found something on the current pass, omit later passes. */
6195 if (count < n_spills)
6196 break;
6197 }
6198
6199 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
6200 if (count >= n_spills)
6201 return 0;
6202
6203 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
6204 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
6205
6206 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
6207 }
6208 \f
6209 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
6210 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
6211 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
6212
6213 static void
6214 choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *chain, rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx)
6215 {
6216 int i;
6217
6218 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6219 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
6220
6221 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
6222 memset (reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
6223 memset (reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
6224
6225 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
6226 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
6227 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
6228 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
6229 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
6230 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
6231
6232 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
6233 {
6234 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
6235 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
6236 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
6237 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
6238 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
6239 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
6240 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
6241 }
6242
6243 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
6244 {
6245 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
6246 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
6247 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
6248 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
6249 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
6250 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
6251 }
6252
6253 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
6254
6255 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
6256
6257 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6258 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
6259 don't use it in another way. */
6260 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
6261 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
6262 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
6263 }
6264
6265 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
6266 into hard regs for this insn.
6267 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
6268
6269 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
6270 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
6271
6272 static void
6273 choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
6274 {
6275 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6276 int i, j;
6277 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
6278 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
6279 int pass, win, inheritance;
6280
6281 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
6282
6283 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
6284 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
6285 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
6286 that provided the reload registers.
6287
6288 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
6289 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
6290 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
6291
6292 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6293 {
6294 reload_order[j] = j;
6295 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != NULL_RTX)
6296 {
6297 gcc_assert (REG_P (rld[j].reg_rtx)
6298 && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx));
6299 reload_spill_index[j] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
6300 }
6301 else
6302 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6303
6304 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
6305 {
6306 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
6307 group_class
6308 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].rclass][(int) group_class];
6309 }
6310
6311 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
6312 }
6313
6314 if (n_reloads > 1)
6315 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
6316
6317 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
6318 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
6319 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
6320 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
6321 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
6322 win = 0;
6323 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
6324 {
6325 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6326
6327 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
6328 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
6329
6330 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
6331 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
6332 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
6333 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
6334 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
6335
6336 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
6337 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
6338 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
6339 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
6340 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
6341
6342 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
6343 that haven't been given registers yet. */
6344
6345 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6346 {
6347 int r = reload_order[j];
6348 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
6349
6350 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
6351 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
6352 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
6353 continue;
6354
6355 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
6356 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
6357 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
6358 around.
6359 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
6360 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
6361 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
6362 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
6363 && !MEM_P (rld[r].in)
6364 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
6365 continue;
6366
6367 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
6368 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
6369 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
6370 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
6371 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
6372 are at the end of reload_order. */
6373 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
6374 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
6375 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
6376 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
6377 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
6378 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
6379 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
6380 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
6381 #endif
6382
6383 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
6384 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
6385 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
6386 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
6387 for the groups.
6388
6389 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
6390 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
6391 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
6392 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
6393 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
6394 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
6395 one of the loads in the case described above. */
6396
6397 if (inheritance)
6398 {
6399 int byte = 0;
6400 int regno = -1;
6401 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6402
6403 if (rld[r].in == 0)
6404 ;
6405 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in))
6406 {
6407 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
6408 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
6409 }
6410 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
6411 {
6412 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
6413 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6414 }
6415 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
6416 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)))
6417 {
6418 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
6419 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6420 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in_reg);
6421 else
6422 byte = SUBREG_BYTE (rld[r].in_reg);
6423 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6424 }
6425 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
6426 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg)) == RTX_AUTOINC
6427 && REG_P (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)))
6428 {
6429 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6430 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6431 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
6432 }
6433 #endif
6434 #if 0
6435 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
6436 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
6437 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
6438 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
6439 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)))
6440 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in);
6441 #endif
6442
6443 if (regno >= 0
6444 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0
6445 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
6446 /* Verify that the register it's in can be used in
6447 mode MODE. */
6448 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6449 GET_MODE (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6450 mode)
6451 #endif
6452 )
6453 {
6454 enum reg_class rclass = rld[r].rclass, last_class;
6455 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
6456 enum machine_mode need_mode;
6457
6458 i = REGNO (last_reg);
6459 i += subreg_regno_offset (i, GET_MODE (last_reg), byte, mode);
6460 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
6461
6462 if (byte == 0)
6463 need_mode = mode;
6464 else
6465 need_mode
6466 = smallest_mode_for_size
6467 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) + byte * BITS_PER_UNIT,
6468 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT
6469 ? MODE_INT : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode));
6470
6471 if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
6472 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode))
6473 && reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
6474 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
6475 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
6476 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rclass], i)
6477 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
6478 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
6479 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
6480 enough. */
6481 || ((register_move_cost (mode, last_class, rclass)
6482 < memory_move_cost (mode, rclass, true))
6483 && (secondary_reload_class (1, rclass, mode,
6484 last_reg)
6485 == NO_REGS)
6486 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6487 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, rclass,
6488 mode)
6489 #endif
6490 ))
6491
6492 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6493 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
6494 i))
6495 && free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
6496 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6497 const0_rtx, r, 1))
6498 {
6499 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
6500 registers still have their values intact. */
6501 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6502 int k;
6503
6504 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
6505 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
6506 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
6507 break;
6508
6509 if (k == nr)
6510 {
6511 int i1;
6512 int bad_for_class;
6513
6514 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
6515 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
6516
6517 bad_for_class = 0;
6518 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6519 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6520 i+k);
6521
6522 /* We found a register that contains the
6523 value we need. If this register is the
6524 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
6525 current insn, just mark it as a place to
6526 reload from since we can't use it as the
6527 reload register itself. */
6528
6529 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
6530 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
6531 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
6532 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
6533 break;
6534
6535 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
6536 || ! (free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode,
6537 rld[r].opnum,
6538 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6539 rld[r].out, r, 1))
6540 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
6541 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
6542 && rld[r].out
6543 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
6544 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
6545 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6546 && frame_pointer_needed
6547 && rld[r].out)
6548 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
6549 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
6550 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
6551 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
6552 || bad_for_class
6553
6554 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
6555 register, stay with it - that leaves the
6556 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
6557 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
6558 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
6559 {
6560 if (! rld[r].optional)
6561 {
6562 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
6563 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6564 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6565 }
6566 }
6567 else
6568 {
6569 int k;
6570 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
6571 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
6572 the insn. */
6573 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
6574 rld[r].opnum,
6575 rld[r].when_needed,
6576 rld[r].mode);
6577 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
6578 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6579 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6580 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6581 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
6582 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6583 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6584 i + k);
6585 }
6586 }
6587 }
6588 }
6589 }
6590
6591 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
6592 if (inheritance
6593 && rld[r].in != 0
6594 && ! reload_inherited[r]
6595 && rld[r].out == 0
6596 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
6597 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
6598 || REG_P (rld[r].in)
6599 || MEM_P (rld[r].in))
6600 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6601 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass, group_class)))
6602 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
6603 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
6604 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
6605 else if (inheritance && rld[r].in == 0 && rld[r].out != 0)
6606 {
6607 rtx set = single_set (insn);
6608
6609 if (set
6610 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, SET_DEST (set))
6611 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
6612 search_equiv = SET_SRC (set);
6613 }
6614
6615 if (search_equiv)
6616 {
6617 rtx equiv
6618 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].rclass,
6619 -1, NULL, 0, rld[r].mode);
6620 int regno = 0;
6621
6622 if (equiv != 0)
6623 {
6624 if (REG_P (equiv))
6625 regno = REGNO (equiv);
6626 else
6627 {
6628 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
6629 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
6630 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
6631 there. */
6632 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG);
6633 regno = subreg_regno (equiv);
6634 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
6635 /* If we choose EQUIV as the reload register, but the
6636 loop below decides to cancel the inheritance, we'll
6637 end up reloading EQUIV in rld[r].mode, not the mode
6638 it had originally. That isn't safe when EQUIV isn't
6639 available as a spill register since its value might
6640 still be live at this point. */
6641 for (i = regno; i < regno + (int) rld[r].nregs; i++)
6642 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, i))
6643 equiv = 0;
6644 }
6645 }
6646
6647 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
6648 and of the desired class. */
6649 if (equiv != 0)
6650 {
6651 int regs_used = 0;
6652 int bad_for_class = 0;
6653 int max_regno = regno + rld[r].nregs;
6654
6655 for (i = regno; i < max_regno; i++)
6656 {
6657 regs_used |= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
6658 i);
6659 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6660 i);
6661 }
6662
6663 if ((regs_used
6664 && ! free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].mode,
6665 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6666 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
6667 || bad_for_class)
6668 equiv = 0;
6669 }
6670
6671 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
6672 equiv = 0;
6673
6674 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
6675 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
6676 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
6677 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
6678
6679 if (equiv != 0)
6680 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
6681 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
6682 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
6683 {
6684 if (! rld[r].optional)
6685 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6686 equiv = 0;
6687 break;
6688 }
6689
6690 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
6691 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
6692 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
6693 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
6694 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
6695
6696 if (equiv != 0)
6697 {
6698 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 2))
6699 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6700 {
6701 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6702 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6703 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6704 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6705 break;
6706 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6707 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6708 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6709 if (! rld[r].optional)
6710 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6711 /* Fall through. */
6712 default:
6713 equiv = 0;
6714 break;
6715 }
6716 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 1))
6717 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6718 {
6719 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6720 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6721 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6722 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6723 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6724 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6725 break;
6726 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6727 if (! rld[r].optional)
6728 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6729 /* Fall through. */
6730 default:
6731 equiv = 0;
6732 break;
6733 }
6734 }
6735
6736 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
6737 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
6738 if (equiv != 0
6739 && (regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6740 || !frame_pointer_needed))
6741 {
6742 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rld[r].mode];
6743 int k;
6744 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
6745 reload_spill_index[r] = regno;
6746 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6747
6748 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
6749 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
6750 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
6751 might delete the store. */
6752 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
6753 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
6754 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
6755 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
6756 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6757 {
6758 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
6759 if (i >= 0)
6760 {
6761 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
6762 rld[r].when_needed,
6763 rld[r].mode);
6764 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6765 regno + k);
6766 }
6767 }
6768 }
6769 }
6770
6771 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
6772 reload, we are done. */
6773 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
6774 continue;
6775
6776 #if 0
6777 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
6778 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
6779
6780 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
6781 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
6782 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
6783 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
6784 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
6785 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
6786 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
6787 turned off. */
6788
6789 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
6790 {
6791 int s = reload_order[i];
6792
6793 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
6794 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
6795 || rld[s].optional)
6796 continue;
6797
6798 if ((rld[s].rclass != rld[r].rclass
6799 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass,
6800 rld[s].rclass))
6801 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
6802 break;
6803 }
6804
6805 if (i == n_reloads)
6806 continue;
6807
6808 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
6809 #endif
6810 }
6811
6812 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
6813 didn't get one yet. */
6814 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6815 {
6816 int r = reload_order[j];
6817
6818 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
6819 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
6820 continue;
6821
6822 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
6823 optional. */
6824 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
6825 continue;
6826
6827 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
6828 break;
6829 }
6830
6831 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
6832 if (j == n_reloads)
6833 {
6834 win = 1;
6835 break;
6836 }
6837
6838 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
6839 }
6840
6841 if (! win)
6842 {
6843 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
6844 to allocate with inheritance. */
6845 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6846
6847 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
6848 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
6849 gcc_assert (chain->n_reloads == n_reloads);
6850
6851 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6852 {
6853 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
6854 continue;
6855 gcc_assert (chain->rld[i].when_needed == rld[i].when_needed);
6856 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
6857 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
6858 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
6859 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
6860 }
6861 }
6862
6863 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
6864 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
6865 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
6866 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
6867
6868 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
6869 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
6870 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
6871 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
6872 {
6873 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6874 {
6875 int r = reload_order[j];
6876 rtx check_reg;
6877 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
6878 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
6879 else if (reload_override_in[r]
6880 && (REG_P (reload_override_in[r])
6881 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
6882 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
6883 else
6884 continue;
6885 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg), rld[r].mode,
6886 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6887 (reload_inherited[r]
6888 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
6889 r, 1))
6890 {
6891 if (pass)
6892 continue;
6893 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
6894 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
6895 }
6896 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
6897 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
6898 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
6899 likewise for other reload types.
6900 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
6901 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
6902 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
6903 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
6904 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
6905 If we succeeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
6906 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
6907 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
6908 else if (rld[r].in
6909 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
6910 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in) && pass)
6911 pass = 2;
6912 }
6913 }
6914
6915 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
6916 actually override reload_in. */
6917 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6918 if (reload_override_in[j])
6919 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
6920
6921 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been canceled or is
6922 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
6923 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
6924 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6925 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6926 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
6927 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
6928 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
6929 {
6930 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
6931
6932 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6933 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
6934 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
6935 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
6936 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6937 }
6938
6939 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
6940 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6941 {
6942 int r = reload_order[j];
6943
6944 i = reload_spill_index[r];
6945
6946 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
6947 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
6948 that we opted to ignore. */
6949 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)
6950 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
6951 {
6952 int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
6953 int nr = 1;
6954
6955 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6956 nr = hard_regno_nregs[nregno][rld[r].mode];
6957
6958 while (--nr >= 0)
6959 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
6960 nregno + nr);
6961
6962 if (i >= 0)
6963 {
6964 nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6965 while (--nr >= 0)
6966 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
6967 }
6968
6969 gcc_assert (rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6970 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
6971 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INSN);
6972 }
6973 }
6974 }
6975
6976 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
6977 remove_address_replacements. */
6978
6979 void
6980 deallocate_reload_reg (int r)
6981 {
6982 int regno;
6983
6984 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
6985 return;
6986 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
6987 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
6988 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6989 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6990 rld[r].mode);
6991 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
6992 }
6993 \f
6994 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
6995 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6996 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6997 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6998 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6999 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7000 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7001 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7002 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7003 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
7004 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
7005 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7006
7007 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
7008 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7009 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
7010
7011 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as an intermediate or scratch register
7012 of class NEW_CLASS with mode NEW_MODE. Or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg
7013 is nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
7014 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
7015 static bool
7016 reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
7017 enum reg_class new_class,
7018 enum machine_mode new_mode)
7019
7020 {
7021 rtx reg;
7022
7023 for (reg = *reload_reg; reg; reg = alt_reload_reg, alt_reload_reg = 0)
7024 {
7025 unsigned regno = REGNO (reg);
7026
7027 if (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class], regno))
7028 continue;
7029 if (GET_MODE (reg) != new_mode)
7030 {
7031 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, new_mode))
7032 continue;
7033 if (hard_regno_nregs[regno][new_mode]
7034 > hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)])
7035 continue;
7036 reg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg, new_mode);
7037 }
7038 *reload_reg = reg;
7039 return true;
7040 }
7041 return false;
7042 }
7043
7044 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as a scratch register for the reload
7045 pattern with insn_code ICODE, or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg is
7046 nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
7047 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
7048 static bool
7049 reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
7050 enum insn_code icode)
7051
7052 {
7053 enum reg_class new_class = scratch_reload_class (icode);
7054 enum machine_mode new_mode = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[2].mode;
7055
7056 return reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (reload_reg, alt_reload_reg,
7057 new_class, new_mode);
7058 }
7059
7060 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
7061 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
7062
7063 static void
7064 emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
7065 rtx old, int j)
7066 {
7067 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7068 rtx reloadreg;
7069 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
7070 rtx oldequiv = 0;
7071 int special = 0;
7072 enum machine_mode mode;
7073 rtx *where;
7074
7075 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
7076 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
7077 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
7078 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
7079 if (reload_override_in[j]
7080 && REG_P (rl->in_reg))
7081 {
7082 oldequiv = old;
7083 old = rl->in_reg;
7084 }
7085 if (oldequiv == 0)
7086 oldequiv = old;
7087 else if (REG_P (oldequiv))
7088 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
7089 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
7090 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
7091
7092 reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j];
7093 mode = GET_MODE (reloadreg);
7094
7095 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
7096 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7097 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7098
7099 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
7100 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7101 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
7102 && REG_P (old)
7103 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
7104 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
7105 rl->out_reg)))
7106 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv), reloadreg);
7107
7108 /* Encapsulate OLDEQUIV into the reload mode, then load RELOADREG from
7109 OLDEQUIV. */
7110
7111 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
7112 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
7113 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
7114 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
7115 oldequiv = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv);
7116
7117 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
7118 switch (rl->when_needed)
7119 {
7120 case RELOAD_OTHER:
7121 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
7122 break;
7123 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
7124 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7125 break;
7126 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
7127 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7128 break;
7129 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
7130 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7131 break;
7132 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
7133 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7134 break;
7135 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
7136 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7137 break;
7138 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
7139 where = &operand_reload_insns;
7140 break;
7141 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
7142 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
7143 break;
7144 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
7145 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
7146 break;
7147 default:
7148 gcc_unreachable ();
7149 }
7150
7151 push_to_sequence (*where);
7152
7153 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
7154 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
7155 {
7156 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
7157 incremented register can't be copied directly from
7158 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
7159 gcc_assert (rl->secondary_in_reload < 0);
7160
7161 if (reload_inherited[j])
7162 oldequiv = reloadreg;
7163
7164 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
7165
7166 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
7167 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7168 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
7169 && REG_P (old)
7170 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
7171 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
7172 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
7173 old)))
7174 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv), reloadreg);
7175
7176 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
7177 special = 1;
7178 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
7179 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (reloadreg)]
7180 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out,
7181 rl->inc);
7182 }
7183
7184 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
7185 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
7186 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
7187
7188 else if (optimize && REG_P (old)
7189 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7190 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
7191 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
7192 uses the same reg first. */
7193 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg)
7194 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg), rl->mode, rl->opnum,
7195 rl->when_needed, old, rl->out, j, 0))
7196 {
7197 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
7198 while (temp && (NOTE_P (temp) || DEBUG_INSN_P (temp)))
7199 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
7200 if (temp
7201 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (temp)
7202 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
7203 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
7204 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
7205 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
7206 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
7207 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
7208 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1)
7209 {
7210 rtx old = SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp));
7211 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
7212 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
7213
7214 /* Verify that resulting insn is valid. */
7215 extract_insn (temp);
7216 if (constrain_operands (1))
7217 {
7218 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
7219 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
7220 contain the previous destination. This is now
7221 invalid. */
7222 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))
7223 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7224 {
7225 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
7226 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
7227 }
7228
7229 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
7230 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
7231 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
7232 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
7233 {
7234 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (reloadreg);
7235 if (ira_conflicts_p)
7236 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
7237 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (old));
7238 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1, false);
7239 }
7240 special = 1;
7241
7242 /* Adjust any debug insns between temp and insn. */
7243 while ((temp = NEXT_INSN (temp)) != insn)
7244 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (temp))
7245 replace_rtx (PATTERN (temp), old, reloadreg);
7246 else
7247 gcc_assert (NOTE_P (temp));
7248 }
7249 else
7250 {
7251 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = old;
7252 }
7253 }
7254 }
7255
7256 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
7257
7258 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
7259 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
7260 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
7261 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
7262 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
7263 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
7264 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
7265 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
7266 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
7267 output need secondary reload registers. */
7268
7269 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7270 {
7271 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
7272 rtx third_reload_reg = 0;
7273 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
7274 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7275 rtx real_old = old;
7276 rtx tmp;
7277 enum insn_code icode;
7278 enum insn_code tertiary_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7279
7280 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
7281 and similarly for OLD.
7282 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
7283 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
7284 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
7285 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
7286 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
7287 equivalent constant.
7288
7289 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
7290 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
7291 not in the right mode. */
7292
7293 tmp = oldequiv;
7294 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7295 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7296 if (REG_P (tmp)
7297 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7298 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
7299 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
7300 {
7301 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
7302 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7303 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
7304 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7305 else
7306 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
7307 }
7308
7309 tmp = old;
7310 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7311 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7312 if (REG_P (tmp)
7313 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7314 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
7315 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
7316 {
7317 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
7318 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7319 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
7320 real_old = rl->in;
7321 else
7322 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
7323 }
7324
7325 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7326 if (rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7327 {
7328 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload;
7329
7330 third_reload_reg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7331 tertiary_icode = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
7332 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7333 gcc_assert (rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_in_reload < 0);
7334 }
7335 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
7336
7337 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
7338 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
7339 {
7340 secondary_reload_info sri, sri2;
7341 enum reg_class new_class, new_t_class;
7342
7343 sri.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7344 sri.prev_sri = NULL;
7345 new_class
7346 = (enum reg_class) targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
7347 rl->rclass, mode,
7348 &sri);
7349
7350 if (new_class == NO_REGS && sri.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7351 second_reload_reg = 0;
7352 else if (new_class == NO_REGS)
7353 {
7354 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&second_reload_reg,
7355 third_reload_reg,
7356 (enum insn_code) sri.icode))
7357 {
7358 icode = (enum insn_code) sri.icode;
7359 third_reload_reg = 0;
7360 }
7361 else
7362 {
7363 oldequiv = old;
7364 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7365 }
7366 }
7367 else if (sri.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7368 /* We currently lack a way to express this in reloads. */
7369 gcc_unreachable ();
7370 else
7371 {
7372 sri2.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7373 sri2.prev_sri = &sri;
7374 new_t_class
7375 = (enum reg_class) targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
7376 new_class, mode,
7377 &sri);
7378 if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7379 {
7380 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&second_reload_reg,
7381 third_reload_reg,
7382 new_class, mode))
7383 {
7384 third_reload_reg = 0;
7385 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7386 }
7387 else
7388 {
7389 oldequiv = old;
7390 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7391 }
7392 }
7393 else if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7394 {
7395 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7396
7397 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7398 new_class, mode)
7399 && reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7400 ((enum insn_code)
7401 sri2.icode)))
7402 {
7403 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7404 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7405 }
7406 else
7407 {
7408 oldequiv = old;
7409 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7410 }
7411 }
7412 else if (new_t_class != NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7413 {
7414 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7415
7416 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7417 new_class, mode)
7418 && reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7419 new_t_class, mode))
7420 {
7421 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7422 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7423 }
7424 else
7425 {
7426 oldequiv = old;
7427 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7428 }
7429 }
7430 else
7431 {
7432 /* This could be handled more intelligently too. */
7433 oldequiv = old;
7434 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7435 }
7436 }
7437 }
7438
7439 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
7440 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
7441 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
7442 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
7443 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
7444 a MEM. */
7445
7446 if (second_reload_reg)
7447 {
7448 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7449 {
7450 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7451 gcc_assert (!third_reload_reg);
7452
7453 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
7454 second_reload_reg));
7455 special = 1;
7456 }
7457 else
7458 {
7459 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
7460 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
7461 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7462 {
7463 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7464 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7465 third_reload_reg)));
7466 }
7467 else if (third_reload_reg)
7468 {
7469 gen_reload (third_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7470 rl->opnum,
7471 rl->when_needed);
7472 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, third_reload_reg,
7473 rl->opnum,
7474 rl->when_needed);
7475 }
7476 else
7477 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7478 rl->opnum,
7479 rl->when_needed);
7480
7481 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
7482 }
7483 }
7484 }
7485
7486 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
7487 {
7488 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7489
7490 if ((REG_P (oldequiv)
7491 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7492 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0
7493 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0))
7494 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
7495 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7496 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7497 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7498 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
7499 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)
7500 || (reg_equiv_constant
7501 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)))
7502 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv)
7503 && (PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (oldequiv,
7504 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg)))
7505 == NO_REGS)))
7506 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7507 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
7508 rl->when_needed);
7509 }
7510
7511 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
7512 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (insn, get_insns (), NULL);
7513
7514 /* End this sequence. */
7515 *where = get_insns ();
7516 end_sequence ();
7517
7518 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
7519 can see the actual register usage. */
7520 if (oldequiv_reg)
7521 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
7522 }
7523
7524 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
7525 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
7526 static void
7527 emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
7528 int j)
7529 {
7530 rtx reloadreg;
7531 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7532 int special = 0;
7533 rtx old = rl->out;
7534 enum machine_mode mode;
7535 rtx p;
7536 rtx rl_reg_rtx;
7537
7538 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7539 start_sequence ();
7540 else
7541 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7542
7543 rl_reg_rtx = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j];
7544 mode = GET_MODE (rl_reg_rtx);
7545
7546 reloadreg = rl_reg_rtx;
7547
7548 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
7549 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
7550 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
7551
7552 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
7553 {
7554 rtx real_old = old;
7555 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7556 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload;
7557
7558 if (REG_P (old) && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7559 && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
7560 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];
7561
7562 if (secondary_reload_class (0, rl->rclass, mode, real_old) != NO_REGS)
7563 {
7564 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
7565 reloadreg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7566
7567 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
7568 or as an intermediate register. */
7569 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7570 {
7571 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7572 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0);
7573
7574 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
7575 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
7576 special = 1;
7577 }
7578 else
7579 {
7580 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
7581 register. */
7582
7583 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
7584 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
7585
7586 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7587 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0
7588 || rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_out_reload < 0);
7589
7590 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
7591 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
7592
7593 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7594 {
7595 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7596 rtx tem;
7597
7598 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
7599 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
7600 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
7601
7602 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
7603 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
7604 RELOADREG. */
7605 if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
7606 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
7607 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
7608 && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
7609 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
7610 reloadreg)))
7611 real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;
7612
7613 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7614 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7615 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7616 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
7617 special = 1;
7618 }
7619
7620 else
7621 {
7622 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
7623 OUT later. */
7624
7625 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7626 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7627 if (tertiary_reload >= 0)
7628 {
7629 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7630
7631 gen_reload (third_reloadreg, reloadreg,
7632 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7633 reloadreg = third_reloadreg;
7634 }
7635 }
7636 }
7637 }
7638 }
7639
7640 /* Output the last reload insn. */
7641 if (! special)
7642 {
7643 rtx set;
7644
7645 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
7646 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
7647 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
7648 || !REG_P (old)
7649 || !(set = single_set (insn))
7650 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
7651 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
7652 || !((REGNO (old) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7653 && regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode, 0)))
7654 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
7655 rl->when_needed);
7656 }
7657
7658 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
7659 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
7660 if (INSN_P (p))
7661 {
7662 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
7663
7664 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
7665 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
7666 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
7667 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
7668 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
7669
7670 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl_reg_rtx, pat))
7671 {
7672 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7673 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
7674 && set
7675 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx)
7676 {
7677 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
7678
7679 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
7680 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
7681 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
7682 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
7683 }
7684 if (HARD_REGISTER_P (rl_reg_rtx))
7685 {
7686 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7687 set = single_set (p);
7688 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
7689 register, the secondary reload does the actual
7690 store. */
7691 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
7692 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
7693 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
7694 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
7695 ;
7696 else if (s >= 0
7697 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx
7698 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
7699 {
7700 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
7701 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
7702 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
7703 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
7704 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
7705 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
7706 rld[s].out = rl->out;
7707 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
7708 set = single_set (next);
7709 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
7710 && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
7711 {
7712 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
7713 REGNO (s_reg));
7714 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
7715 }
7716 }
7717 else
7718 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl_reg_rtx)] = p;
7719 }
7720 }
7721 }
7722
7723 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7724 {
7725 emit_insn (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7726 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7727 }
7728 else
7729 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7730
7731 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
7732 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (insn, get_insns (), NULL);
7733
7734 end_sequence ();
7735 }
7736
7737 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
7738 and has the number J. */
7739 static void
7740 do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7741 {
7742 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7743 rtx old = (rl->in && MEM_P (rl->in)
7744 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
7745 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
7746
7747 if (old && reg_rtx)
7748 {
7749 enum machine_mode mode;
7750
7751 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
7752 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
7753 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
7754 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
7755 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
7756 by stripping some SUBREGs.
7757 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
7758 we can change that arbitrarily.
7759
7760 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
7761 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
7762 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
7763 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
7764 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
7765 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
7766 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
7767
7768 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
7769 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
7770 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
7771 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
7772
7773 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
7774 to get a mode from something else.
7775
7776 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
7777 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
7778 this operand, it overrides all others.
7779
7780 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
7781 but it does the right things in those cases. */
7782
7783 mode = GET_MODE (old);
7784 if (mode == VOIDmode)
7785 mode = rl->inmode;
7786
7787 /* We cannot use gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing
7788 when REG_RTX has a multi-word mode. Note that REG_RTX must
7789 always be a REG here. */
7790 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
7791 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
7792 }
7793 reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j] = reg_rtx;
7794
7795 if (old != 0
7796 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
7797 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
7798 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
7799 && ! rtx_equal_p (reg_rtx, old)
7800 && reg_rtx != 0)
7801 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
7802
7803 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
7804 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
7805 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
7806 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
7807 && MEM_P (rl->in)
7808 && MEM_P (rl->in_reg)
7809 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
7810 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
7811 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
7812
7813 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
7814 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7815 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7816
7817 if (optimize
7818 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
7819 && reg_rtx
7820 && REG_P (reg_rtx)
7821 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (reg_rtx)] != 0
7822 #if 0
7823 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
7824 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
7825 register of the wrong class. */
7826 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7827 #endif
7828 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
7829 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
7830 original pseudo. */
7831 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7832 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)], rl->out_reg)))
7833 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (reg_rtx), reg_rtx);
7834 }
7835
7836 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
7837 CHAIN and has the number J.
7838 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
7839 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
7840 static void
7841 do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7842 {
7843 rtx note, old;
7844 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7845 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
7846 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
7847 store. */
7848 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
7849 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
7850
7851 if (rl->out && reg_rtx)
7852 {
7853 enum machine_mode mode;
7854
7855 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
7856 See comments above (for input reloading). */
7857 mode = GET_MODE (rl->out);
7858 if (mode == VOIDmode)
7859 {
7860 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
7861 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
7862 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
7863 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
7864 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in %<asm%>");
7865 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
7866 mode = word_mode;
7867 rl->out = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reg_rtx));
7868 }
7869 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
7870 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
7871 }
7872 reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j] = reg_rtx;
7873
7874 if (pseudo
7875 && optimize
7876 && REG_P (pseudo)
7877 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
7878 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7879 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
7880 {
7881 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
7882 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
7883
7884 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
7885 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
7886 matches the pseudo. */
7887 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
7888 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
7889 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
7890 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
7891 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno, reg_rtx);
7892 }
7893
7894 old = rl->out_reg;
7895 if (old == 0
7896 || reg_rtx == 0
7897 || rtx_equal_p (old, reg_rtx))
7898 return;
7899
7900 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
7901 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
7902 REG_UNUSED note. */
7903 if ((REG_P (old) || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7904 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
7905 {
7906 XEXP (note, 0) = reg_rtx;
7907 return;
7908 }
7909 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
7910 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
7911 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (old))
7912 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
7913 SUBREG_REG (old))))
7914 {
7915 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old), reg_rtx);
7916 return;
7917 }
7918 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7919 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
7920 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
7921 return;
7922
7923 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
7924 gcc_assert (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn));
7925
7926 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
7927 }
7928
7929 /* A reload copies values of MODE from register SRC to register DEST.
7930 Return true if it can be treated for inheritance purposes like a
7931 group of reloads, each one reloading a single hard register. The
7932 caller has already checked that (reg:MODE SRC) and (reg:MODE DEST)
7933 occupy the same number of hard registers. */
7934
7935 static bool
7936 inherit_piecemeal_p (int dest ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7937 int src ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7938 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7939 {
7940 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
7941 return (!REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (dest, mode, reg_raw_mode[dest])
7942 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (src, mode, reg_raw_mode[src]));
7943 #else
7944 return true;
7945 #endif
7946 }
7947
7948 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
7949
7950 static void
7951 emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain)
7952 {
7953 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7954
7955 int j;
7956
7957 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
7958
7959 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7960 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
7961 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7962 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
7963 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7964 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
7965 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
7966 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
7967 operand_reload_insns = 0;
7968 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
7969
7970 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
7971 if (dump_file)
7972 {
7973 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
7974 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
7975 }
7976
7977 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
7978 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
7979 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
7980 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
7981
7982 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7983 {
7984 if (rld[j].reg_rtx && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx))
7985 {
7986 unsigned int i;
7987
7988 for (i = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i < END_REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i++)
7989 new_spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
7990 }
7991
7992 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7993 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7994 }
7995
7996 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
7997 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
7998 the following reloads:
7999
8000 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
8001
8002 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
8003
8004 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
8005 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
8006 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
8007
8008 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
8009
8010 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
8011
8012 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
8013
8014 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
8015 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
8016 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
8017 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
8018 output in descending order by reload number. */
8019
8020 emit_insn_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
8021 emit_insn_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
8022
8023 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
8024 {
8025 emit_insn_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8026 emit_insn_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8027 emit_insn_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
8028 }
8029
8030 emit_insn_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
8031 emit_insn_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
8032
8033 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
8034 {
8035 rtx x = emit_insn_after (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8036 x = emit_insn_after (output_address_reload_insns[j], x);
8037 x = emit_insn_after (output_reload_insns[j], x);
8038 emit_insn_after (other_output_reload_insns[j], x);
8039 }
8040
8041 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
8042 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
8043 can inherit the reloads.
8044
8045 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
8046 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
8047
8048 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
8049 {
8050 int r = reload_order[j];
8051 int i = reload_spill_index[r];
8052
8053 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
8054 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
8055 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
8056 being reloaded. */
8057 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
8058 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
8059 {
8060 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
8061
8062 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
8063 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
8064
8065 if (REG_P (reg)
8066 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8067 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, REGNO (reg)))
8068 {
8069 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
8070
8071 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
8072 {
8073 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
8074
8075 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
8076 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
8077 }
8078 }
8079 }
8080
8081 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
8082 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
8083 that we opted to ignore. */
8084
8085 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
8086 {
8087 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)];
8088 int k;
8089
8090 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
8091 of the value lives to the end. */
8092 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
8093 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, rld[r].opnum,
8094 rld[r].when_needed))
8095 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
8096
8097 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
8098 if (rld[r].out != 0
8099 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8100 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8101 || ! rld[r].out_reg
8102 #endif
8103 || REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)))
8104 {
8105 rtx reg;
8106 enum machine_mode mode;
8107 int regno, nregs;
8108
8109 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
8110 mode = GET_MODE (reg);
8111 regno = REGNO (reg);
8112 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
8113 if (reload_regs_reach_end_p (regno, nregs, rld[r].opnum,
8114 rld[r].when_needed))
8115 {
8116 rtx out = (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8117 ? rld[r].out
8118 : rld[r].out_reg
8119 ? rld[r].out_reg
8120 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
8121 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
8122 int out_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) ? 1
8123 : hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode]);
8124 bool piecemeal;
8125
8126 spill_reg_store[regno] = new_spill_reg_store[regno];
8127 spill_reg_stored_to[regno] = out;
8128 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = reg;
8129
8130 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno)
8131 && nregs == out_nregs
8132 && inherit_piecemeal_p (out_regno, regno, mode));
8133
8134 /* If OUT_REGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
8135 one register. If it does, say what is in the
8136 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
8137 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
8138 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
8139
8140 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
8141 for (k = 1; k < out_nregs; k++)
8142 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k]
8143 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
8144
8145 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
8146 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
8147 {
8148 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
8149 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
8150 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) || !piecemeal
8151 ? out_regno
8152 : out_regno + k);
8153 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
8154 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
8155 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
8156 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8157 regno + k);
8158 else
8159 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8160 regno + k);
8161 }
8162 }
8163 }
8164 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
8165 something if there will not be an output reload for
8166 the register being reloaded. */
8167 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
8168 && rld[r].in != 0
8169 && ((REG_P (rld[r].in)
8170 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[r].in)
8171 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
8172 REGNO (rld[r].in)))
8173 || (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg)
8174 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
8175 REGNO (rld[r].in_reg))))
8176 && !reg_set_p (reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r], PATTERN (insn)))
8177 {
8178 rtx reg;
8179 enum machine_mode mode;
8180 int regno, nregs;
8181
8182 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r];
8183 mode = GET_MODE (reg);
8184 regno = REGNO (reg);
8185 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
8186 if (reload_regs_reach_end_p (regno, nregs, rld[r].opnum,
8187 rld[r].when_needed))
8188 {
8189 int in_regno;
8190 int in_nregs;
8191 rtx in;
8192 bool piecemeal;
8193
8194 if (REG_P (rld[r].in)
8195 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8196 in = rld[r].in;
8197 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
8198 in = rld[r].in_reg;
8199 else
8200 in = XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0);
8201 in_regno = REGNO (in);
8202
8203 in_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) ? 1
8204 : hard_regno_nregs[in_regno][mode]);
8205
8206 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] = reg;
8207
8208 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno)
8209 && nregs == in_nregs
8210 && inherit_piecemeal_p (regno, in_regno, mode));
8211
8212 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno))
8213 for (k = 1; k < in_nregs; k++)
8214 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno + k]
8215 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
8216
8217 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
8218 recently done a store.
8219 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
8220 also have to be discarded. */
8221 if (! reload_inherited[r]
8222 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
8223 spill_reg_store[regno] = 0;
8224
8225 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
8226 {
8227 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
8228 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
8229 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) || !piecemeal
8230 ? in_regno
8231 : in_regno + k);
8232 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
8233 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
8234 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
8235 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8236 regno + k);
8237 else
8238 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8239 regno + k);
8240 }
8241 }
8242 }
8243 }
8244
8245 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
8246 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
8247 deals with this problem. */
8248
8249 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
8250 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
8251 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
8252 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here.
8253 Also do the same thing for RELOAD_OTHER constraints where the
8254 output is discarded. */
8255 if (i < 0
8256 && ((rld[r].out != 0
8257 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8258 || (MEM_P (rld[r].out)
8259 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
8260 || (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].out_reg
8261 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
8262 {
8263 rtx out = ((rld[r].out && REG_P (rld[r].out))
8264 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
8265 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
8266 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (out);
8267
8268 /* REG_RTX is now set or clobbered by the main instruction.
8269 As the comment above explains, forget_old_reloads_1 only
8270 sees the original instruction, and there is no guarantee
8271 that the original instruction also clobbered REG_RTX.
8272 For example, if find_reloads sees that the input side of
8273 a matched operand pair dies in this instruction, it may
8274 use the input register as the reload register.
8275
8276 Calling forget_old_reloads_1 is a waste of effort if
8277 REG_RTX is also the output register.
8278
8279 If we know that REG_RTX holds the value of a pseudo
8280 register, the code after the call will record that fact. */
8281 if (rld[r].reg_rtx && rld[r].reg_rtx != out)
8282 forget_old_reloads_1 (rld[r].reg_rtx, NULL_RTX, NULL);
8283
8284 if (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
8285 {
8286 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
8287
8288 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = 0;
8289
8290 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
8291 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
8292 delete_output_reload. */
8293 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
8294
8295 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
8296 from an input reload. */
8297 if (! src_reg)
8298 {
8299 rtx set = single_set (insn);
8300 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
8301 {
8302 int k;
8303
8304 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
8305 store_insn = insn;
8306 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
8307 {
8308 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
8309 {
8310 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[k];
8311 break;
8312 }
8313 }
8314 }
8315 }
8316 else
8317 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
8318 if (src_reg && REG_P (src_reg)
8319 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8320 {
8321 int src_regno, src_nregs, k;
8322 rtx note;
8323
8324 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (src_reg) == mode);
8325 src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
8326 src_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[src_regno][mode];
8327 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
8328 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
8329 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
8330 notes, so just check both locations. */
8331 note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8332 if (! note && store_insn)
8333 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8334 for (k = 0; k < src_nregs; k++)
8335 {
8336 spill_reg_store[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8337 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + k] = out;
8338 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + k] = out_regno;
8339 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8340 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + k);
8341 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + k);
8342 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (src_regno + k,
8343 mode))
8344 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8345 src_regno + k);
8346 else
8347 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8348 src_regno + k);
8349 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + k);
8350 if (note)
8351 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8352 else
8353 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8354 }
8355 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = src_reg;
8356 /* We have to set reg_has_output_reload here, or else
8357 forget_old_reloads_1 will clear reg_last_reload_reg
8358 right away. */
8359 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
8360 out_regno);
8361 }
8362 }
8363 else
8364 {
8365 int k, out_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode];
8366
8367 for (k = 0; k < out_nregs; k++)
8368 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k] = 0;
8369 }
8370 }
8371 }
8372 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
8373 }
8374 \f
8375 /* Go through the motions to emit INSN and test if it is strictly valid.
8376 Return the emitted insn if valid, else return NULL. */
8377
8378 static rtx
8379 emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx insn)
8380 {
8381 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8382 int code;
8383
8384 insn = emit_insn (insn);
8385 code = recog_memoized (insn);
8386
8387 if (code >= 0)
8388 {
8389 extract_insn (insn);
8390 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in its
8391 validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload has
8392 completed. */
8393 if (constrain_operands (1))
8394 return insn;
8395 }
8396
8397 delete_insns_since (last);
8398 return NULL;
8399 }
8400
8401 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
8402 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
8403 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
8404
8405 Returns first insn emitted. */
8406
8407 static rtx
8408 gen_reload (rtx out, rtx in, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
8409 {
8410 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8411 rtx tem;
8412
8413 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
8414 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
8415 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
8416 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
8417 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
8418 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
8419 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
8420 else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
8421 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
8422 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
8423 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
8424 out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;
8425
8426 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
8427 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
8428 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
8429 call emit_move_insn.
8430
8431 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
8432 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
8433 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
8434 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
8435 we use a two insn sequence.
8436
8437 Or we can be asked to reload an unary operand that was a fragment of
8438 an addressing mode, into a register. If it isn't recognized as-is,
8439 we try making the unop operand and the reload-register the same:
8440 (set reg:X (unop:X expr:Y))
8441 -> (set reg:Y expr:Y) (set reg:X (unop:X reg:Y)).
8442
8443 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
8444 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
8445 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
8446 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
8447 be valid on machines that use 'o').
8448
8449 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
8450 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
8451 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
8452 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
8453 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
8454 here. The one listed above seems to work.
8455
8456 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
8457
8458 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
8459 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
8460 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
8461 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
8462 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8463 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
8464 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8465 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
8466 {
8467 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
8468 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
8469 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
8470 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
8471
8472 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
8473 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
8474
8475 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
8476 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
8477 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
8478 not valid than to dummy things up. */
8479
8480 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
8481 int code;
8482
8483 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8484 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
8485
8486 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
8487 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
8488 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
8489 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
8490 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
8491 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
8492
8493 if (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8494 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
8495 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8496
8497 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
8498 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
8499
8500 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8501 if (insn)
8502 return insn;
8503
8504 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
8505
8506 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
8507 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
8508 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
8509 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
8510 reload OP1.
8511
8512 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
8513 the reload register to the output register.
8514
8515 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
8516 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
8517 we emit below. */
8518
8519 code = (int) optab_handler (add_optab, GET_MODE (out));
8520
8521 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || MEM_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
8522 || (REG_P (op1)
8523 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8524 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
8525 && ! ((*insn_data[code].operand[2].predicate)
8526 (op1, insn_data[code].operand[2].mode))))
8527 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8528
8529 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
8530
8531 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
8532 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
8533 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
8534
8535 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
8536 op1 = out;
8537
8538 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
8539 if (insn)
8540 {
8541 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
8542 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8543 return insn;
8544 }
8545
8546 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
8547 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
8548
8549 gcc_assert (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (out, op0));
8550 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
8551 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
8552 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8553 }
8554
8555 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
8556 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
8557 else if ((REG_P (in)
8558 || (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (in))))
8559 && reg_or_subregno (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8560 && (REG_P (out)
8561 || (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (out))))
8562 && reg_or_subregno (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8563 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (in)),
8564 REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (out)),
8565 GET_MODE (out)))
8566 {
8567 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
8568 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
8569
8570 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
8571 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));
8572
8573 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
8574 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));
8575
8576 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
8577 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
8578 }
8579 #endif
8580 else if (REG_P (out) && UNARY_P (in))
8581 {
8582 rtx insn;
8583 rtx op1;
8584 rtx out_moded;
8585 rtx set;
8586
8587 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8588 if (op1 != XEXP (in, 0))
8589 in = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in), op1);
8590
8591 /* First, try a plain SET. */
8592 set = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8593 if (set)
8594 return set;
8595
8596 /* If that failed, move the inner operand to the reload
8597 register, and try the same unop with the inner expression
8598 replaced with the reload register. */
8599
8600 if (GET_MODE (op1) != GET_MODE (out))
8601 out_moded = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (op1), REGNO (out));
8602 else
8603 out_moded = out;
8604
8605 gen_reload (out_moded, op1, opnum, type);
8606
8607 insn
8608 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out,
8609 gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in),
8610 out_moded));
8611 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (insn);
8612 if (insn)
8613 {
8614 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8615 return insn;
8616 }
8617
8618 fatal_insn ("Failure trying to reload:", set);
8619 }
8620 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
8621 else if (OBJECT_P (in) || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
8622 {
8623 tem = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
8624 /* IN may contain a LABEL_REF, if so add a REG_LABEL_OPERAND note. */
8625 mark_jump_label (in, tem, 0);
8626 }
8627
8628 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
8629 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
8630 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
8631 #endif
8632
8633 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
8634 else
8635 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8636
8637 /* Return the first insn emitted.
8638 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
8639 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
8640 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
8641 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
8642
8643 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
8644 }
8645 \f
8646 /* Delete a previously made output-reload whose result we now believe
8647 is not needed. First we double-check.
8648
8649 INSN is the insn now being processed.
8650 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
8651 the last output reload.
8652 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
8653 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input.
8654 NEW_RELOAD_REG is reload register that reload J is using for REG. */
8655
8656 static void
8657 delete_output_reload (rtx insn, int j, int last_reload_reg, rtx new_reload_reg)
8658 {
8659 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
8660 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
8661 int k;
8662 int n_occurrences;
8663 int n_inherited = 0;
8664 rtx i1;
8665 rtx substed;
8666 unsigned regno;
8667 int nregs;
8668
8669 /* It is possible that this reload has been only used to set another reload
8670 we eliminated earlier and thus deleted this instruction too. */
8671 if (INSN_DELETED_P (output_reload_insn))
8672 return;
8673
8674 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
8675
8676 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
8677 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
8678 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (reg)];
8679
8680 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
8681 insn than it is inherited. */
8682 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
8683 {
8684 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
8685 if (! reg2)
8686 continue;
8687 if (MEM_P (reg2) || reload_override_in[k])
8688 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
8689 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8690 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
8691 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
8692 #endif
8693 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
8694 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
8695 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
8696 {
8697 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
8698 n_inherited++;
8699 else
8700 return;
8701 }
8702 }
8703 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
8704 if (CALL_P (insn) && CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn))
8705 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
8706 reg, 0);
8707 if (substed)
8708 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn),
8709 eliminate_regs (substed, VOIDmode,
8710 NULL_RTX), 0);
8711 for (i1 = reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[REGNO (reg)]; i1; i1 = XEXP (i1, 1))
8712 {
8713 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (XEXP (i1, 0), substed));
8714 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), XEXP (i1, 0), 0);
8715 }
8716 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
8717 return;
8718
8719 regno = REGNO (reg);
8720 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8721 nregs = 1;
8722 else
8723 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)];
8724
8725 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
8726 anywhere between the store into it and here,
8727 and we're within the same basic block, then the value can only
8728 pass through the reload reg and end up here.
8729 Otherwise, give up--return. */
8730 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
8731 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
8732 {
8733 if (NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK_P (i1))
8734 return;
8735 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) || CALL_P (i1))
8736 && refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + nregs, PATTERN (i1), NULL))
8737 {
8738 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
8739 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
8740 while (NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
8741 {
8742 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
8743 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
8744 }
8745 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
8746 break;
8747 return;
8748 }
8749 }
8750
8751 /* We will be deleting the insn. Remove the spill reg information. */
8752 for (k = hard_regno_nregs[last_reload_reg][GET_MODE (reg)]; k-- > 0; )
8753 {
8754 spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8755 spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8756 }
8757
8758 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
8759 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some
8760 inaccuracies in the debugging information are acceptable.
8761 So we could just delete output_reload_insn. But in some cases
8762 we can improve the debugging information without sacrificing
8763 optimization - maybe even improving the code: See if the pseudo
8764 reg has been completely replaced with reload regs. If so, delete
8765 the store insn and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
8766 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
8767 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8768 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8769 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
8770 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
8771 {
8772 rtx i2;
8773
8774 /* We know that it was used only between here and the beginning of
8775 the current basic block. (We also know that the last use before
8776 INSN was the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never
8777 mind that.) Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
8778 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8779 {
8780 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8781
8782 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
8783 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
8784 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8785 continue;
8786 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8787 || JUMP_P (i2))
8788 break;
8789 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i2) || CALL_P (i2))
8790 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
8791 {
8792 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
8793 know to be dead. */
8794 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8795 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8796 return;
8797 }
8798 }
8799
8800 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. Note that this
8801 loop also takes care of deleting output_reload_insn. */
8802 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8803 {
8804 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8805
8806 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8807 {
8808 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
8809 delete_insn (i2);
8810 }
8811 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8812 || JUMP_P (i2))
8813 break;
8814 }
8815
8816 /* For the debugging info, say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
8817 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (new_reload_reg);
8818 if (ira_conflicts_p)
8819 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
8820 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (reg));
8821 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1, false);
8822 }
8823 else
8824 {
8825 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8826 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8827 }
8828 }
8829
8830 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
8831 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
8832 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
8833 static void
8834 delete_address_reloads (rtx dead_insn, rtx current_insn)
8835 {
8836 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
8837 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
8838 if (set)
8839 {
8840 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
8841 if (MEM_P (dst))
8842 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
8843 }
8844 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
8845 we can delete the matching adds. */
8846 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
8847 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
8848 if (! prev || ! next)
8849 return;
8850 set = single_set (next);
8851 set2 = single_set (prev);
8852 if (! set || ! set2
8853 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
8854 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
8855 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)))
8856 return;
8857 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8858 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
8859 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
8860 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
8861 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
8862 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
8863 return;
8864 delete_related_insns (prev);
8865 delete_related_insns (next);
8866 }
8867
8868 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
8869 static void
8870 delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx dead_insn, rtx x, rtx current_insn)
8871 {
8872 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
8873 int i, j;
8874 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8875
8876 if (code != REG)
8877 {
8878 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8879 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8880 {
8881 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8882 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
8883 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8884 {
8885 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8886 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
8887 current_insn);
8888 }
8889 }
8890 return;
8891 }
8892
8893 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
8894 return;
8895
8896 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
8897 to inheritance. */
8898 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
8899 {
8900 code = GET_CODE (prev);
8901 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
8902 return;
8903 if (!INSN_P (prev))
8904 continue;
8905 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8906 break;
8907 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8908 return;
8909 }
8910 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
8911 return;
8912 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
8913 set = single_set (prev);
8914 if (! set)
8915 return;
8916 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8917 if (!REG_P (dst)
8918 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
8919 return;
8920 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
8921 {
8922 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
8923 it might have been inherited. */
8924 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
8925 {
8926 if (LABEL_P (i2))
8927 break;
8928 if (! INSN_P (i2))
8929 continue;
8930 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8931 {
8932 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
8933 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
8934 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
8935 referenced. */
8936 if (i2 == current_insn)
8937 {
8938 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8939 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8940 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8941 return;
8942 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8943 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
8944 break;
8945 if (j >= 0)
8946 break;
8947 }
8948 return;
8949 }
8950 if (JUMP_P (i2))
8951 break;
8952 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
8953 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
8954 have to check the reloads. */
8955 if (i2 == current_insn)
8956 {
8957 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8958 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8959 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8960 return;
8961 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
8962 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
8963 block needs any of the classes containing DST - see
8964 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
8965 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
8966 }
8967 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8968 break;
8969 }
8970 }
8971 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
8972 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
8973 delete_insn (prev);
8974 }
8975 \f
8976 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
8977 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
8978 is a register or memory location;
8979 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
8980 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
8981
8982 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
8983 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
8984
8985 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
8986
8987 static rtx
8988 inc_for_reload (rtx reloadreg, rtx in, rtx value, int inc_amount)
8989 {
8990 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
8991 rtx incloc = find_replacement (&XEXP (value, 0));
8992 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
8993 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC
8994 || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY);
8995 rtx last;
8996 rtx inc;
8997 rtx add_insn;
8998 int code;
8999 rtx store;
9000 rtx real_in = in == value ? incloc : in;
9001
9002 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
9003 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were nonzero,
9004 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
9005 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
9006 if (REG_P (incloc))
9007 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
9008
9009 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_MODIFY || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY)
9010 {
9011 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == PLUS);
9012 inc = find_replacement (&XEXP (XEXP (value, 1), 1));
9013 }
9014 else
9015 {
9016 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
9017 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
9018
9019 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
9020 }
9021
9022 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
9023 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
9024 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
9025
9026 if (in == value)
9027 {
9028 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
9029 that in gen_reload. */
9030
9031 last = get_last_insn ();
9032 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
9033 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
9034 incloc, inc)));
9035
9036 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
9037 if (code >= 0)
9038 {
9039 extract_insn (add_insn);
9040 if (constrain_operands (1))
9041 {
9042 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
9043 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
9044 be used as an address. */
9045
9046 if (! post)
9047 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
9048
9049 return add_insn;
9050 }
9051 }
9052 delete_insns_since (last);
9053 }
9054
9055 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
9056 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
9057 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
9058 there, then save back. */
9059
9060 if (! post)
9061 {
9062 if (in != reloadreg)
9063 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
9064 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9065 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
9066 }
9067 else
9068 {
9069 /* Postincrement.
9070 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
9071 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
9072 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
9073
9074 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
9075 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
9076 the original value. */
9077
9078 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9079 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
9080 if (CONST_INT_P (inc))
9081 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-INTVAL (inc))));
9082 else
9083 emit_insn (gen_sub2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9084 }
9085
9086 return store;
9087 }
9088 \f
9089 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
9090 static void
9091 add_auto_inc_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
9092 {
9093 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
9094 const char *fmt;
9095 int i, j;
9096
9097 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
9098 {
9099 add_reg_note (insn, REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
9100 return;
9101 }
9102
9103 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
9104 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9105 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9106 {
9107 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9108 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
9109 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9110 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9111 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
9112 }
9113 }
9114 #endif
9115
9116 /* This is used by reload pass, that does emit some instructions after
9117 abnormal calls moving basic block end, but in fact it wants to emit
9118 them on the edge. Looks for abnormal call edges, find backward the
9119 proper call and fix the damage.
9120
9121 Similar handle instructions throwing exceptions internally. */
9122 void
9123 fixup_abnormal_edges (void)
9124 {
9125 bool inserted = false;
9126 basic_block bb;
9127
9128 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
9129 {
9130 edge e;
9131 edge_iterator ei;
9132
9133 /* Look for cases we are interested in - calls or instructions causing
9134 exceptions. */
9135 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
9136 {
9137 if (e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL_CALL)
9138 break;
9139 if ((e->flags & (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
9140 == (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
9141 break;
9142 }
9143 if (e && !CALL_P (BB_END (bb))
9144 && !can_throw_internal (BB_END (bb)))
9145 {
9146 rtx insn;
9147
9148 /* Get past the new insns generated. Allow notes, as the insns
9149 may be already deleted. */
9150 insn = BB_END (bb);
9151 while ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
9152 && !can_throw_internal (insn)
9153 && insn != BB_HEAD (bb))
9154 insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
9155
9156 if (CALL_P (insn) || can_throw_internal (insn))
9157 {
9158 rtx stop, next;
9159
9160 stop = NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb));
9161 BB_END (bb) = insn;
9162 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
9163
9164 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
9165 if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
9166 break;
9167
9168 while (insn && insn != stop)
9169 {
9170 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
9171 if (INSN_P (insn))
9172 {
9173 delete_insn (insn);
9174
9175 /* Sometimes there's still the return value USE.
9176 If it's placed after a trapping call (i.e. that
9177 call is the last insn anyway), we have no fallthru
9178 edge. Simply delete this use and don't try to insert
9179 on the non-existent edge. */
9180 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE)
9181 {
9182 /* We're not deleting it, we're moving it. */
9183 INSN_DELETED_P (insn) = 0;
9184 PREV_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
9185 NEXT_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
9186
9187 insert_insn_on_edge (insn, e);
9188 inserted = true;
9189 }
9190 }
9191 else if (!BARRIER_P (insn))
9192 set_block_for_insn (insn, NULL);
9193 insn = next;
9194 }
9195 }
9196
9197 /* It may be that we don't find any such trapping insn. In this
9198 case we discovered quite late that the insn that had been
9199 marked as can_throw_internal in fact couldn't trap at all.
9200 So we should in fact delete the EH edges out of the block. */
9201 else
9202 purge_dead_edges (bb);
9203 }
9204 }
9205
9206 /* We've possibly turned single trapping insn into multiple ones. */
9207 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
9208 {
9209 sbitmap blocks;
9210 blocks = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
9211 sbitmap_ones (blocks);
9212 find_many_sub_basic_blocks (blocks);
9213 sbitmap_free (blocks);
9214 }
9215
9216 if (inserted)
9217 commit_edge_insertions ();
9218
9219 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9220 /* Verify that we didn't turn one trapping insn into many, and that
9221 we found and corrected all of the problems wrt fixups on the
9222 fallthru edge. */
9223 verify_flow_info ();
9224 #endif
9225 }